mirror of
https://github.com/c64scene-ar/llvm-6502.git
synced 2025-02-22 13:29:44 +00:00
Intrinsic::dbg_stoppoint Intrinsic::dbg_region_start Intrinsic::dbg_region_end Intrinsic::dbg_func_start AutoUpgrade simply ignores these intrinsics now. git-svn-id: https://llvm.org/svn/llvm-project/llvm/trunk@92557 91177308-0d34-0410-b5e6-96231b3b80d8
8951 lines
346 KiB
C++
8951 lines
346 KiB
C++
//===- InstructionCombining.cpp - Combine multiple instructions -----------===//
|
|
//
|
|
// The LLVM Compiler Infrastructure
|
|
//
|
|
// This file is distributed under the University of Illinois Open Source
|
|
// License. See LICENSE.TXT for details.
|
|
//
|
|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
|
|
//
|
|
// InstructionCombining - Combine instructions to form fewer, simple
|
|
// instructions. This pass does not modify the CFG. This pass is where
|
|
// algebraic simplification happens.
|
|
//
|
|
// This pass combines things like:
|
|
// %Y = add i32 %X, 1
|
|
// %Z = add i32 %Y, 1
|
|
// into:
|
|
// %Z = add i32 %X, 2
|
|
//
|
|
// This is a simple worklist driven algorithm.
|
|
//
|
|
// This pass guarantees that the following canonicalizations are performed on
|
|
// the program:
|
|
// 1. If a binary operator has a constant operand, it is moved to the RHS
|
|
// 2. Bitwise operators with constant operands are always grouped so that
|
|
// shifts are performed first, then or's, then and's, then xor's.
|
|
// 3. Compare instructions are converted from <,>,<=,>= to ==,!= if possible
|
|
// 4. All cmp instructions on boolean values are replaced with logical ops
|
|
// 5. add X, X is represented as (X*2) => (X << 1)
|
|
// 6. Multiplies with a power-of-two constant argument are transformed into
|
|
// shifts.
|
|
// ... etc.
|
|
//
|
|
//===----------------------------------------------------------------------===//
|
|
|
|
#define DEBUG_TYPE "instcombine"
|
|
#include "llvm/Transforms/Scalar.h"
|
|
#include "InstCombine.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/IntrinsicInst.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/LLVMContext.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/DerivedTypes.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/GlobalVariable.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Operator.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Analysis/ConstantFolding.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Analysis/InstructionSimplify.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Analysis/MemoryBuiltins.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Target/TargetData.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/BasicBlockUtils.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Transforms/Utils/Local.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Support/CallSite.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Support/Debug.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Support/ErrorHandling.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Support/GetElementPtrTypeIterator.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Support/MathExtras.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/Support/PatternMatch.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/ADT/SmallPtrSet.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/ADT/Statistic.h"
|
|
#include "llvm/ADT/STLExtras.h"
|
|
#include <algorithm>
|
|
#include <climits>
|
|
using namespace llvm;
|
|
using namespace llvm::PatternMatch;
|
|
|
|
STATISTIC(NumCombined , "Number of insts combined");
|
|
STATISTIC(NumConstProp, "Number of constant folds");
|
|
STATISTIC(NumDeadInst , "Number of dead inst eliminated");
|
|
STATISTIC(NumDeadStore, "Number of dead stores eliminated");
|
|
STATISTIC(NumSunkInst , "Number of instructions sunk");
|
|
|
|
|
|
char InstCombiner::ID = 0;
|
|
static RegisterPass<InstCombiner>
|
|
X("instcombine", "Combine redundant instructions");
|
|
|
|
void InstCombiner::getAnalysisUsage(AnalysisUsage &AU) const {
|
|
AU.addPreservedID(LCSSAID);
|
|
AU.setPreservesCFG();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// isOnlyUse - Return true if this instruction will be deleted if we stop using
|
|
// it.
|
|
static bool isOnlyUse(Value *V) {
|
|
return V->hasOneUse() || isa<Constant>(V);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// getPromotedType - Return the specified type promoted as it would be to pass
|
|
// though a va_arg area...
|
|
static const Type *getPromotedType(const Type *Ty) {
|
|
if (const IntegerType* ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(Ty)) {
|
|
if (ITy->getBitWidth() < 32)
|
|
return Type::getInt32Ty(Ty->getContext());
|
|
}
|
|
return Ty;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// ShouldChangeType - Return true if it is desirable to convert a computation
|
|
/// from 'From' to 'To'. We don't want to convert from a legal to an illegal
|
|
/// type for example, or from a smaller to a larger illegal type.
|
|
bool InstCombiner::ShouldChangeType(const Type *From, const Type *To) const {
|
|
assert(isa<IntegerType>(From) && isa<IntegerType>(To));
|
|
|
|
// If we don't have TD, we don't know if the source/dest are legal.
|
|
if (!TD) return false;
|
|
|
|
unsigned FromWidth = From->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
|
|
unsigned ToWidth = To->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
|
|
bool FromLegal = TD->isLegalInteger(FromWidth);
|
|
bool ToLegal = TD->isLegalInteger(ToWidth);
|
|
|
|
// If this is a legal integer from type, and the result would be an illegal
|
|
// type, don't do the transformation.
|
|
if (FromLegal && !ToLegal)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, if both are illegal, do not increase the size of the result. We
|
|
// do allow things like i160 -> i64, but not i64 -> i160.
|
|
if (!FromLegal && !ToLegal && ToWidth > FromWidth)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// getBitCastOperand - If the specified operand is a CastInst, a constant
|
|
/// expression bitcast, or a GetElementPtrInst with all zero indices, return the
|
|
/// operand value, otherwise return null.
|
|
static Value *getBitCastOperand(Value *V) {
|
|
if (Operator *O = dyn_cast<Operator>(V)) {
|
|
if (O->getOpcode() == Instruction::BitCast)
|
|
return O->getOperand(0);
|
|
if (GEPOperator *GEP = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(V))
|
|
if (GEP->hasAllZeroIndices())
|
|
return GEP->getPointerOperand();
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// SimplifyCommutative - This performs a few simplifications for commutative
|
|
// operators:
|
|
//
|
|
// 1. Order operands such that they are listed from right (least complex) to
|
|
// left (most complex). This puts constants before unary operators before
|
|
// binary operators.
|
|
//
|
|
// 2. Transform: (op (op V, C1), C2) ==> (op V, (op C1, C2))
|
|
// 3. Transform: (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
|
|
//
|
|
bool InstCombiner::SimplifyCommutative(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = false;
|
|
if (getComplexity(I.getOperand(0)) < getComplexity(I.getOperand(1)))
|
|
Changed = !I.swapOperands();
|
|
|
|
if (!I.isAssociative()) return Changed;
|
|
Instruction::BinaryOps Opcode = I.getOpcode();
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (Op->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(),
|
|
cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1)),
|
|
cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1)));
|
|
I.setOperand(0, Op->getOperand(0));
|
|
I.setOperand(1, Folded);
|
|
return true;
|
|
} else if (BinaryOperator *Op1=dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (Op1->getOpcode() == Opcode && isa<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
isOnlyUse(Op) && isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
|
|
Constant *C1 = cast<Constant>(Op->getOperand(1));
|
|
Constant *C2 = cast<Constant>(Op1->getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
// Fold (op (op V1, C1), (op V2, C2)) ==> (op (op V1, V2), (op C1,C2))
|
|
Constant *Folded = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), C1, C2);
|
|
Instruction *New = BinaryOperator::Create(Opcode, Op->getOperand(0),
|
|
Op1->getOperand(0),
|
|
Op1->getName(), &I);
|
|
Worklist.Add(New);
|
|
I.setOperand(0, New);
|
|
I.setOperand(1, Folded);
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return Changed;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// dyn_castNegVal - Given a 'sub' instruction, return the RHS of the instruction
|
|
// if the LHS is a constant zero (which is the 'negate' form).
|
|
//
|
|
Value *InstCombiner::dyn_castNegVal(Value *V) const {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator::isNeg(V))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::getNegArgument(V);
|
|
|
|
// Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
|
|
return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
|
|
if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isInteger())
|
|
return ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// dyn_castFNegVal - Given a 'fsub' instruction, return the RHS of the
|
|
// instruction if the LHS is a constant negative zero (which is the 'negate'
|
|
// form).
|
|
//
|
|
static inline Value *dyn_castFNegVal(Value *V) {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator::isFNeg(V))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::getFNegArgument(V);
|
|
|
|
// Constants can be considered to be negated values if they can be folded.
|
|
if (ConstantFP *C = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(V))
|
|
return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
|
|
if (C->getType()->getElementType()->isFloatingPoint())
|
|
return ConstantExpr::getFNeg(C);
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// MatchSelectPattern - Pattern match integer [SU]MIN, [SU]MAX, and ABS idioms,
|
|
/// returning the kind and providing the out parameter results if we
|
|
/// successfully match.
|
|
static SelectPatternFlavor
|
|
MatchSelectPattern(Value *V, Value *&LHS, Value *&RHS) {
|
|
SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(V);
|
|
if (SI == 0) return SPF_UNKNOWN;
|
|
|
|
ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI->getCondition());
|
|
if (ICI == 0) return SPF_UNKNOWN;
|
|
|
|
LHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
|
|
RHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// (icmp X, Y) ? X : Y
|
|
if (SI->getTrueValue() == ICI->getOperand(0) &&
|
|
SI->getFalseValue() == ICI->getOperand(1)) {
|
|
switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
|
|
default: return SPF_UNKNOWN; // Equality.
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return SPF_UMAX;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return SPF_SMAX;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return SPF_UMIN;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return SPF_SMIN;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (icmp X, Y) ? Y : X
|
|
if (SI->getTrueValue() == ICI->getOperand(1) &&
|
|
SI->getFalseValue() == ICI->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
|
|
default: return SPF_UNKNOWN; // Equality.
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return SPF_UMIN;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return SPF_SMIN;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return SPF_UMAX;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return SPF_SMAX;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// TODO: (X > 4) ? X : 5 --> (X >= 5) ? X : 5 --> MAX(X, 5)
|
|
|
|
return SPF_UNKNOWN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// isFreeToInvert - Return true if the specified value is free to invert (apply
|
|
/// ~ to). This happens in cases where the ~ can be eliminated.
|
|
static inline bool isFreeToInvert(Value *V) {
|
|
// ~(~(X)) -> X.
|
|
if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Constants can be considered to be not'ed values.
|
|
if (isa<ConstantInt>(V))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Compares can be inverted if they have a single use.
|
|
if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(V))
|
|
return CI->hasOneUse();
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static inline Value *dyn_castNotVal(Value *V) {
|
|
// If this is not(not(x)) don't return that this is a not: we want the two
|
|
// not's to be folded first.
|
|
if (BinaryOperator::isNot(V)) {
|
|
Value *Operand = BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(V);
|
|
if (!isFreeToInvert(Operand))
|
|
return Operand;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Constants can be considered to be not'ed values...
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(V))
|
|
return ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), ~C->getValue());
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
// dyn_castFoldableMul - If this value is a multiply that can be folded into
|
|
// other computations (because it has a constant operand), return the
|
|
// non-constant operand of the multiply, and set CST to point to the multiplier.
|
|
// Otherwise, return null.
|
|
//
|
|
static inline Value *dyn_castFoldableMul(Value *V, ConstantInt *&CST) {
|
|
if (V->hasOneUse() && V->getType()->isInteger())
|
|
if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul)
|
|
if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))))
|
|
return I->getOperand(0);
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
|
|
if ((CST = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1)))) {
|
|
// The multiplier is really 1 << CST.
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(V->getType())->getBitWidth();
|
|
uint32_t CSTVal = CST->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
|
|
CST = ConstantInt::get(V->getType()->getContext(),
|
|
APInt(BitWidth, 1).shl(CSTVal));
|
|
return I->getOperand(0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// AddOne - Add one to a ConstantInt
|
|
static Constant *AddOne(Constant *C) {
|
|
return ConstantExpr::getAdd(C, ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
|
|
}
|
|
/// SubOne - Subtract one from a ConstantInt
|
|
static Constant *SubOne(ConstantInt *C) {
|
|
return ConstantExpr::getSub(C, ConstantInt::get(C->getType(), 1));
|
|
}
|
|
/// MultiplyOverflows - True if the multiply can not be expressed in an int
|
|
/// this size.
|
|
static bool MultiplyOverflows(ConstantInt *C1, ConstantInt *C2, bool sign) {
|
|
uint32_t W = C1->getBitWidth();
|
|
APInt LHSExt = C1->getValue(), RHSExt = C2->getValue();
|
|
if (sign) {
|
|
LHSExt.sext(W * 2);
|
|
RHSExt.sext(W * 2);
|
|
} else {
|
|
LHSExt.zext(W * 2);
|
|
RHSExt.zext(W * 2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
APInt MulExt = LHSExt * RHSExt;
|
|
|
|
if (!sign)
|
|
return MulExt.ugt(APInt::getLowBitsSet(W * 2, W));
|
|
|
|
APInt Min = APInt::getSignedMinValue(W).sext(W * 2);
|
|
APInt Max = APInt::getSignedMaxValue(W).sext(W * 2);
|
|
return MulExt.slt(Min) || MulExt.sgt(Max);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// AssociativeOpt - Perform an optimization on an associative operator. This
|
|
/// function is designed to check a chain of associative operators for a
|
|
/// potential to apply a certain optimization. Since the optimization may be
|
|
/// applicable if the expression was reassociated, this checks the chain, then
|
|
/// reassociates the expression as necessary to expose the optimization
|
|
/// opportunity. This makes use of a special Functor, which must define
|
|
/// 'shouldApply' and 'apply' methods.
|
|
///
|
|
template<typename Functor>
|
|
static Instruction *AssociativeOpt(BinaryOperator &Root, const Functor &F) {
|
|
unsigned Opcode = Root.getOpcode();
|
|
Value *LHS = Root.getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
// Quick check, see if the immediate LHS matches...
|
|
if (F.shouldApply(LHS))
|
|
return F.apply(Root);
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, if the LHS is not of the same opcode as the root, return.
|
|
Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
|
|
while (LHSI && LHSI->getOpcode() == Opcode && LHSI->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// Should we apply this transform to the RHS?
|
|
bool ShouldApply = F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
// If not to the RHS, check to see if we should apply to the LHS...
|
|
if (!ShouldApply && F.shouldApply(LHSI->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
cast<BinaryOperator>(LHSI)->swapOperands(); // Make the LHS the RHS
|
|
ShouldApply = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the functor wants to apply the optimization to the RHS of LHSI,
|
|
// reassociate the expression from ((? op A) op B) to (? op (A op B))
|
|
if (ShouldApply) {
|
|
// Now all of the instructions are in the current basic block, go ahead
|
|
// and perform the reassociation.
|
|
Instruction *TmpLHSI = cast<Instruction>(Root.getOperand(0));
|
|
|
|
// First move the selected RHS to the LHS of the root...
|
|
Root.setOperand(0, LHSI->getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
// Make what used to be the LHS of the root be the user of the root...
|
|
Value *ExtraOperand = TmpLHSI->getOperand(1);
|
|
if (&Root == TmpLHSI) {
|
|
Root.replaceAllUsesWith(Constant::getNullValue(TmpLHSI->getType()));
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
Root.replaceAllUsesWith(TmpLHSI); // Users now use TmpLHSI
|
|
TmpLHSI->setOperand(1, &Root); // TmpLHSI now uses the root
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator ARI = &Root; ++ARI;
|
|
TmpLHSI->moveBefore(ARI); // Move TmpLHSI to after Root
|
|
ARI = Root;
|
|
|
|
// Now propagate the ExtraOperand down the chain of instructions until we
|
|
// get to LHSI.
|
|
while (TmpLHSI != LHSI) {
|
|
Instruction *NextLHSI = cast<Instruction>(TmpLHSI->getOperand(0));
|
|
// Move the instruction to immediately before the chain we are
|
|
// constructing to avoid breaking dominance properties.
|
|
NextLHSI->moveBefore(ARI);
|
|
ARI = NextLHSI;
|
|
|
|
Value *NextOp = NextLHSI->getOperand(1);
|
|
NextLHSI->setOperand(1, ExtraOperand);
|
|
TmpLHSI = NextLHSI;
|
|
ExtraOperand = NextOp;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Now that the instructions are reassociated, have the functor perform
|
|
// the transformation...
|
|
return F.apply(Root);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHSI->getOperand(0));
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
namespace {
|
|
|
|
// AddRHS - Implements: X + X --> X << 1
|
|
struct AddRHS {
|
|
Value *RHS;
|
|
explicit AddRHS(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
|
|
bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
|
|
Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Add.getOperand(0),
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Add.getType(), 1));
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
// AddMaskingAnd - Implements (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2)
|
|
// iff C1&C2 == 0
|
|
struct AddMaskingAnd {
|
|
Constant *C2;
|
|
explicit AddMaskingAnd(Constant *c) : C2(c) {}
|
|
bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const {
|
|
ConstantInt *C1;
|
|
return match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
|
|
ConstantExpr::getAnd(C1, C2)->isNullValue();
|
|
}
|
|
Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Add) const {
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Add.getOperand(0), Add.getOperand(1));
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static Value *FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Instruction &I, Value *SO,
|
|
InstCombiner *IC) {
|
|
if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(&I))
|
|
return IC->Builder->CreateCast(CI->getOpcode(), SO, I.getType());
|
|
|
|
// Figure out if the constant is the left or the right argument.
|
|
bool ConstIsRHS = isa<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
|
|
Constant *ConstOperand = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(ConstIsRHS));
|
|
|
|
if (Constant *SOC = dyn_cast<Constant>(SO)) {
|
|
if (ConstIsRHS)
|
|
return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), SOC, ConstOperand);
|
|
return ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), ConstOperand, SOC);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *Op0 = SO, *Op1 = ConstOperand;
|
|
if (!ConstIsRHS)
|
|
std::swap(Op0, Op1);
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
|
|
return IC->Builder->CreateBinOp(BO->getOpcode(), Op0, Op1,
|
|
SO->getName()+".op");
|
|
if (ICmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(&I))
|
|
return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
|
|
SO->getName()+".cmp");
|
|
if (FCmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(&I))
|
|
return IC->Builder->CreateICmp(CI->getPredicate(), Op0, Op1,
|
|
SO->getName()+".cmp");
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Unknown binary instruction type!");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// FoldOpIntoSelect - Given an instruction with a select as one operand and a
|
|
// constant as the other operand, try to fold the binary operator into the
|
|
// select arguments. This also works for Cast instructions, which obviously do
|
|
// not have a second operand.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoSelect(Instruction &Op, SelectInst *SI) {
|
|
// Don't modify shared select instructions
|
|
if (!SI->hasOneUse()) return 0;
|
|
Value *TV = SI->getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *FV = SI->getOperand(2);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(TV) || isa<Constant>(FV)) {
|
|
// Bool selects with constant operands can be folded to logical ops.
|
|
if (SI->getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(SI->getContext())) return 0;
|
|
|
|
Value *SelectTrueVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, TV, this);
|
|
Value *SelectFalseVal = FoldOperationIntoSelectOperand(Op, FV, this);
|
|
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), SelectTrueVal,
|
|
SelectFalseVal);
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// FoldOpIntoPhi - Given a binary operator, cast instruction, or select which
|
|
/// has a PHI node as operand #0, see if we can fold the instruction into the
|
|
/// PHI (which is only possible if all operands to the PHI are constants).
|
|
///
|
|
/// If AllowAggressive is true, FoldOpIntoPhi will allow certain transforms
|
|
/// that would normally be unprofitable because they strongly encourage jump
|
|
/// threading.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOpIntoPhi(Instruction &I,
|
|
bool AllowAggressive) {
|
|
AllowAggressive = false;
|
|
PHINode *PN = cast<PHINode>(I.getOperand(0));
|
|
unsigned NumPHIValues = PN->getNumIncomingValues();
|
|
if (NumPHIValues == 0 ||
|
|
// We normally only transform phis with a single use, unless we're trying
|
|
// hard to make jump threading happen.
|
|
(!PN->hasOneUse() && !AllowAggressive))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if all of the operands of the PHI are simple constants
|
|
// (constantint/constantfp/undef). If there is one non-constant value,
|
|
// remember the BB it is in. If there is more than one or if *it* is a PHI,
|
|
// bail out. We don't do arbitrary constant expressions here because moving
|
|
// their computation can be expensive without a cost model.
|
|
BasicBlock *NonConstBB = 0;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i)
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)) ||
|
|
isa<ConstantExpr>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
|
|
if (NonConstBB) return 0; // More than one non-const value.
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) return 0; // Itself a phi.
|
|
NonConstBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
|
|
|
|
// If the incoming non-constant value is in I's block, we have an infinite
|
|
// loop.
|
|
if (NonConstBB == I.getParent())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If there is exactly one non-constant value, we can insert a copy of the
|
|
// operation in that block. However, if this is a critical edge, we would be
|
|
// inserting the computation one some other paths (e.g. inside a loop). Only
|
|
// do this if the pred block is unconditionally branching into the phi block.
|
|
if (NonConstBB != 0 && !AllowAggressive) {
|
|
BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(NonConstBB->getTerminator());
|
|
if (!BI || !BI->isUnconditional()) return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we can do the transformation: create the new PHI node.
|
|
PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(I.getType(), "");
|
|
NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN->getNumOperands()/2);
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, *PN);
|
|
NewPN->takeName(PN);
|
|
|
|
// Next, add all of the operands to the PHI.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(&I)) {
|
|
// We only currently try to fold the condition of a select when it is a phi,
|
|
// not the true/false values.
|
|
Value *TrueV = SI->getTrueValue();
|
|
Value *FalseV = SI->getFalseValue();
|
|
BasicBlock *PhiTransBB = PN->getParent();
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
|
|
BasicBlock *ThisBB = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
|
|
Value *TrueVInPred = TrueV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
|
|
Value *FalseVInPred = FalseV->DoPHITranslation(PhiTransBB, ThisBB);
|
|
Value *InV = 0;
|
|
if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
|
|
InV = InC->isNullValue() ? FalseVInPred : TrueVInPred;
|
|
} else {
|
|
assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
|
|
InV = SelectInst::Create(PN->getIncomingValue(i), TrueVInPred,
|
|
FalseVInPred,
|
|
"phitmp", NonConstBB->getTerminator());
|
|
Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
|
|
}
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(InV, ThisBB);
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (I.getNumOperands() == 2) {
|
|
Constant *C = cast<Constant>(I.getOperand(1));
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
|
|
Value *InV = 0;
|
|
if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
|
|
if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
|
|
InV = ConstantExpr::getCompare(CI->getPredicate(), InC, C);
|
|
else
|
|
InV = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), InC, C);
|
|
} else {
|
|
assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(&I))
|
|
InV = BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(),
|
|
PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
|
|
NonConstBB->getTerminator());
|
|
else if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(&I))
|
|
InV = CmpInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(),
|
|
CI->getPredicate(),
|
|
PN->getIncomingValue(i), C, "phitmp",
|
|
NonConstBB->getTerminator());
|
|
else
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Unknown binop!");
|
|
|
|
Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
|
|
}
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
|
|
}
|
|
} else {
|
|
CastInst *CI = cast<CastInst>(&I);
|
|
const Type *RetTy = CI->getType();
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumPHIValues; ++i) {
|
|
Value *InV;
|
|
if (Constant *InC = dyn_cast<Constant>(PN->getIncomingValue(i))) {
|
|
InV = ConstantExpr::getCast(CI->getOpcode(), InC, RetTy);
|
|
} else {
|
|
assert(PN->getIncomingBlock(i) == NonConstBB);
|
|
InV = CastInst::Create(CI->getOpcode(), PN->getIncomingValue(i),
|
|
I.getType(), "phitmp",
|
|
NonConstBB->getTerminator());
|
|
Worklist.Add(cast<Instruction>(InV));
|
|
}
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(InV, PN->getIncomingBlock(i));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, NewPN);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// WillNotOverflowSignedAdd - Return true if we can prove that:
|
|
/// (sext (add LHS, RHS)) === (add (sext LHS), (sext RHS))
|
|
/// This basically requires proving that the add in the original type would not
|
|
/// overflow to change the sign bit or have a carry out.
|
|
bool InstCombiner::WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
|
|
// There are different heuristics we can use for this. Here are some simple
|
|
// ones.
|
|
|
|
// Add has the property that adding any two 2's complement numbers can only
|
|
// have one carry bit which can change a sign. As such, if LHS and RHS each
|
|
// have at least two sign bits, we know that the addition of the two values
|
|
// will sign extend fine.
|
|
if (ComputeNumSignBits(LHS) > 1 && ComputeNumSignBits(RHS) > 1)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
|
|
// If one of the operands only has one non-zero bit, and if the other operand
|
|
// has a known-zero bit in a more significant place than it (not including the
|
|
// sign bit) the ripple may go up to and fill the zero, but won't change the
|
|
// sign. For example, (X & ~4) + 1.
|
|
|
|
// TODO: Implement.
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Value *V = SimplifyAddInst(LHS, RHS, I.hasNoSignedWrap(),
|
|
I.hasNoUnsignedWrap(), TD))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)) {
|
|
// X + (signbit) --> X ^ signbit
|
|
const APInt& Val = CI->getValue();
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = Val.getBitWidth();
|
|
if (Val == APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
|
|
|
|
// See if SimplifyDemandedBits can simplify this. This handles stuff like
|
|
// (X & 254)+1 -> (X&254)|1
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
|
|
// zext(bool) + C -> bool ? C + 1 : C
|
|
if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(LHS))
|
|
if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(I.getContext()))
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), AddOne(CI), CI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
|
|
ConstantInt *XorRHS = 0;
|
|
Value *XorLHS = 0;
|
|
if (isa<ConstantInt>(RHSC) &&
|
|
match(LHS, m_Xor(m_Value(XorLHS), m_ConstantInt(XorRHS)))) {
|
|
uint32_t TySizeBits = I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
|
|
const APInt& RHSVal = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSC)->getValue();
|
|
|
|
uint32_t Size = TySizeBits / 2;
|
|
APInt C0080Val(APInt(TySizeBits, 1ULL).shl(Size - 1));
|
|
APInt CFF80Val(-C0080Val);
|
|
do {
|
|
if (TySizeBits > Size) {
|
|
// If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0x80), 0xF..F80), it's a sext.
|
|
// If we have ADD(XOR(AND(X, 0xFF), 0xF..F80), 0x80), it's a sext.
|
|
if ((RHSVal == CFF80Val && XorRHS->getValue() == C0080Val) ||
|
|
(RHSVal == C0080Val && XorRHS->getValue() == CFF80Val)) {
|
|
// This is a sign extend if the top bits are known zero.
|
|
if (!MaskedValueIsZero(XorLHS,
|
|
APInt::getHighBitsSet(TySizeBits, TySizeBits - Size)))
|
|
Size = 0; // Not a sign ext, but can't be any others either.
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
Size >>= 1;
|
|
C0080Val = APIntOps::lshr(C0080Val, Size);
|
|
CFF80Val = APIntOps::ashr(CFF80Val, Size);
|
|
} while (Size >= 1);
|
|
|
|
// FIXME: This shouldn't be necessary. When the backends can handle types
|
|
// with funny bit widths then this switch statement should be removed. It
|
|
// is just here to get the size of the "middle" type back up to something
|
|
// that the back ends can handle.
|
|
const Type *MiddleType = 0;
|
|
switch (Size) {
|
|
default: break;
|
|
case 32:
|
|
case 16:
|
|
case 8: MiddleType = IntegerType::get(I.getContext(), Size); break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (MiddleType) {
|
|
Value *NewTrunc = Builder->CreateTrunc(XorLHS, MiddleType, "sext");
|
|
return new SExtInst(NewTrunc, I.getType(), I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(I.getContext()))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(LHS, RHS);
|
|
|
|
// X + X --> X << 1
|
|
if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
|
|
if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, AddRHS(RHS)))
|
|
return Result;
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RHS)) {
|
|
if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
|
|
if (LHS == RHSI->getOperand(1)) // A + (B - A) --> B
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHSI->getOperand(0));
|
|
}
|
|
if (Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS)) {
|
|
if (LHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub)
|
|
if (RHS == LHSI->getOperand(1)) // (B - A) + A --> B
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHSI->getOperand(0));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// -A + B --> B - A
|
|
// -A + -B --> -(A + B)
|
|
if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castNegVal(LHS)) {
|
|
if (LHS->getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
|
|
if (Value *RHSV = dyn_castNegVal(RHS)) {
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(LHSV, RHSV, "sum");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(NewAdd);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(RHS, LHSV);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// A + -B --> A - B
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
|
|
if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(RHS))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, V);
|
|
|
|
|
|
ConstantInt *C2;
|
|
if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(LHS, C2)) {
|
|
if (X == RHS) // X*C + X --> X * (C+1)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(RHS, AddOne(C2));
|
|
|
|
// X*C1 + X*C2 --> X * (C1+C2)
|
|
ConstantInt *C1;
|
|
if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C1))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getAdd(C1, C2));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// X + X*C --> X * (C+1)
|
|
if (dyn_castFoldableMul(RHS, C2) == LHS)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, AddOne(C2));
|
|
|
|
// X + ~X --> -1 since ~X = -X-1
|
|
if (dyn_castNotVal(LHS) == RHS ||
|
|
dyn_castNotVal(RHS) == LHS)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
|
|
// (A & C1)+(B & C2) --> (A & C1)|(B & C2) iff C1&C2 == 0
|
|
if (match(RHS, m_And(m_Value(), m_ConstantInt(C2))))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, AddMaskingAnd(C2)))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
// A+B --> A|B iff A and B have no bits set in common.
|
|
if (const IntegerType *IT = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType())) {
|
|
APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(IT->getBitWidth());
|
|
APInt LHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
|
|
APInt LHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
|
|
ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
|
|
if (LHSKnownZero != 0) {
|
|
APInt RHSKnownOne(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
|
|
APInt RHSKnownZero(IT->getBitWidth(), 0);
|
|
ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
|
|
|
|
// No bits in common -> bitwise or.
|
|
if ((LHSKnownZero|RHSKnownZero).isAllOnesValue())
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(LHS, RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// W*X + Y*Z --> W * (X+Z) iff W == Y
|
|
if (I.getType()->isIntOrIntVector()) {
|
|
Value *W, *X, *Y, *Z;
|
|
if (match(LHS, m_Mul(m_Value(W), m_Value(X))) &&
|
|
match(RHS, m_Mul(m_Value(Y), m_Value(Z)))) {
|
|
if (W != Y) {
|
|
if (W == Z) {
|
|
std::swap(Y, Z);
|
|
} else if (Y == X) {
|
|
std::swap(W, X);
|
|
} else if (X == Z) {
|
|
std::swap(Y, Z);
|
|
std::swap(W, X);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (W == Y) {
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, Z, LHS->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(W, NewAdd);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
|
|
Value *X = 0;
|
|
if (match(LHS, m_Not(m_Value(X)))) // ~X + C --> (C-1) - X
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(SubOne(CRHS), X);
|
|
|
|
// (X & FF00) + xx00 -> (X+xx00) & FF00
|
|
if (LHS->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(LHS, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C2)))) {
|
|
Constant *Anded = ConstantExpr::getAnd(CRHS, C2);
|
|
if (Anded == CRHS) {
|
|
// See if all bits from the first bit set in the Add RHS up are included
|
|
// in the mask. First, get the rightmost bit.
|
|
const APInt& AddRHSV = CRHS->getValue();
|
|
|
|
// Form a mask of all bits from the lowest bit added through the top.
|
|
APInt AddRHSHighBits(~((AddRHSV & -AddRHSV)-1));
|
|
|
|
// See if the and mask includes all of these bits.
|
|
APInt AddRHSHighBitsAnd(AddRHSHighBits & C2->getValue());
|
|
|
|
if (AddRHSHighBits == AddRHSHighBitsAnd) {
|
|
// Okay, the xform is safe. Insert the new add pronto.
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateAdd(X, CRHS, LHS->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewAdd, C2);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant add into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// add (select X 0 (sub n A)) A --> select X A n
|
|
{
|
|
SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(LHS);
|
|
Value *A = RHS;
|
|
if (!SI) {
|
|
SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(RHS);
|
|
A = LHS;
|
|
}
|
|
if (SI && SI->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Value *TV = SI->getTrueValue();
|
|
Value *FV = SI->getFalseValue();
|
|
Value *N;
|
|
|
|
// Can we fold the add into the argument of the select?
|
|
// We check both true and false select arguments for a matching subtract.
|
|
if (match(FV, m_Zero()) &&
|
|
match(TV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
|
|
// Fold the add into the true select value.
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), N, A);
|
|
if (match(TV, m_Zero()) &&
|
|
match(FV, m_Sub(m_Value(N), m_Specific(A))))
|
|
// Fold the add into the false select value.
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), A, N);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Check for (add (sext x), y), see if we can merge this into an
|
|
// integer add followed by a sext.
|
|
if (SExtInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(LHS)) {
|
|
// (add (sext x), cst) --> (sext (add x, cst'))
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS)) {
|
|
Constant *CI =
|
|
ConstantExpr::getTrunc(RHSC, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
|
|
if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
ConstantExpr::getSExt(CI, I.getType()) == RHSC &&
|
|
WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
|
|
// Insert the new, smaller add.
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
|
|
CI, "addconv");
|
|
return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (add (sext x), (sext y)) --> (sext (add int x, y))
|
|
if (SExtInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SExtInst>(RHS)) {
|
|
// Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
|
|
// single use (so we don't increase the number of sexts), and if the
|
|
// integer add will not overflow.
|
|
if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
|
|
(LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
|
|
WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
|
|
RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
// Insert the new integer add.
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
|
|
RHSConv->getOperand(0), "addconv");
|
|
return new SExtInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFAdd(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *LHS = I.getOperand(0), *RHS = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Constant *RHSC = dyn_cast<Constant>(RHS)) {
|
|
// X + 0 --> X
|
|
if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHSC)) {
|
|
if (CFP->isExactlyValue(ConstantFP::getNegativeZero
|
|
(I.getType())->getValueAPF()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(LHS))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// -A + B --> B - A
|
|
// -A + -B --> -(A + B)
|
|
if (Value *LHSV = dyn_castFNegVal(LHS))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(RHS, LHSV);
|
|
|
|
// A + -B --> A - B
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(RHS))
|
|
if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(RHS))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFSub(LHS, V);
|
|
|
|
// Check for X+0.0. Simplify it to X if we know X is not -0.0.
|
|
if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS))
|
|
if (CFP->getValueAPF().isPosZero() && CannotBeNegativeZero(LHS))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
|
|
// Check for (add double (sitofp x), y), see if we can merge this into an
|
|
// integer add followed by a promotion.
|
|
if (SIToFPInst *LHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(LHS)) {
|
|
// (add double (sitofp x), fpcst) --> (sitofp (add int x, intcst))
|
|
// ... if the constant fits in the integer value. This is useful for things
|
|
// like (double)(x & 1234) + 4.0 -> (double)((X & 1234)+4) which no longer
|
|
// requires a constant pool load, and generally allows the add to be better
|
|
// instcombined.
|
|
if (ConstantFP *CFP = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS)) {
|
|
Constant *CI =
|
|
ConstantExpr::getFPToSI(CFP, LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType());
|
|
if (LHSConv->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
ConstantExpr::getSIToFP(CI, I.getType()) == CFP &&
|
|
WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0), CI)) {
|
|
// Insert the new integer add.
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
|
|
CI, "addconv");
|
|
return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (add double (sitofp x), (sitofp y)) --> (sitofp (add int x, y))
|
|
if (SIToFPInst *RHSConv = dyn_cast<SIToFPInst>(RHS)) {
|
|
// Only do this if x/y have the same type, if at last one of them has a
|
|
// single use (so we don't increase the number of int->fp conversions),
|
|
// and if the integer add will not overflow.
|
|
if (LHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()==RHSConv->getOperand(0)->getType()&&
|
|
(LHSConv->hasOneUse() || RHSConv->hasOneUse()) &&
|
|
WillNotOverflowSignedAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
|
|
RHSConv->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
// Insert the new integer add.
|
|
Value *NewAdd = Builder->CreateNSWAdd(LHSConv->getOperand(0),
|
|
RHSConv->getOperand(0),"addconv");
|
|
return new SIToFPInst(NewAdd, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// EmitGEPOffset - Given a getelementptr instruction/constantexpr, emit the
|
|
/// code necessary to compute the offset from the base pointer (without adding
|
|
/// in the base pointer). Return the result as a signed integer of intptr size.
|
|
Value *InstCombiner::EmitGEPOffset(User *GEP) {
|
|
TargetData &TD = *getTargetData();
|
|
gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
|
|
const Type *IntPtrTy = TD.getIntPtrType(GEP->getContext());
|
|
Value *Result = Constant::getNullValue(IntPtrTy);
|
|
|
|
// Build a mask for high order bits.
|
|
unsigned IntPtrWidth = TD.getPointerSizeInBits();
|
|
uint64_t PtrSizeMask = ~0ULL >> (64-IntPtrWidth);
|
|
|
|
for (User::op_iterator i = GEP->op_begin() + 1, e = GEP->op_end(); i != e;
|
|
++i, ++GTI) {
|
|
Value *Op = *i;
|
|
uint64_t Size = TD.getTypeAllocSize(GTI.getIndexedType()) & PtrSizeMask;
|
|
if (ConstantInt *OpC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op)) {
|
|
if (OpC->isZero()) continue;
|
|
|
|
// Handle a struct index, which adds its field offset to the pointer.
|
|
if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(*GTI)) {
|
|
Size = TD.getStructLayout(STy)->getElementOffset(OpC->getZExtValue());
|
|
|
|
Result = Builder->CreateAdd(Result,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size),
|
|
GEP->getName()+".offs");
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
|
|
Constant *OC =
|
|
ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(OpC, IntPtrTy, true /*SExt*/);
|
|
Scale = ConstantExpr::getMul(OC, Scale);
|
|
// Emit an add instruction.
|
|
Result = Builder->CreateAdd(Result, Scale, GEP->getName()+".offs");
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
// Convert to correct type.
|
|
if (Op->getType() != IntPtrTy)
|
|
Op = Builder->CreateIntCast(Op, IntPtrTy, true, Op->getName()+".c");
|
|
if (Size != 1) {
|
|
Constant *Scale = ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, Size);
|
|
// We'll let instcombine(mul) convert this to a shl if possible.
|
|
Op = Builder->CreateMul(Op, Scale, GEP->getName()+".idx");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Emit an add instruction.
|
|
Result = Builder->CreateAdd(Op, Result, GEP->getName()+".offs");
|
|
}
|
|
return Result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// Optimize pointer differences into the same array into a size. Consider:
|
|
/// &A[10] - &A[0]: we should compile this to "10". LHS/RHS are the pointer
|
|
/// operands to the ptrtoint instructions for the LHS/RHS of the subtract.
|
|
///
|
|
Value *InstCombiner::OptimizePointerDifference(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
|
|
const Type *Ty) {
|
|
assert(TD && "Must have target data info for this");
|
|
|
|
// If LHS is a gep based on RHS or RHS is a gep based on LHS, we can optimize
|
|
// this.
|
|
bool Swapped = false;
|
|
GetElementPtrInst *GEP = 0;
|
|
ConstantExpr *CstGEP = 0;
|
|
|
|
// TODO: Could also optimize &A[i] - &A[j] -> "i-j", and "&A.foo[i] - &A.foo".
|
|
// For now we require one side to be the base pointer "A" or a constant
|
|
// expression derived from it.
|
|
if (GetElementPtrInst *LHSGEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(LHS)) {
|
|
// (gep X, ...) - X
|
|
if (LHSGEP->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
|
|
GEP = LHSGEP;
|
|
Swapped = false;
|
|
} else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(RHS)) {
|
|
// (gep X, ...) - (ce_gep X, ...)
|
|
if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
|
|
LHSGEP->getOperand(0) == CE->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
CstGEP = CE;
|
|
GEP = LHSGEP;
|
|
Swapped = false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (GetElementPtrInst *RHSGEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(RHS)) {
|
|
// X - (gep X, ...)
|
|
if (RHSGEP->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
|
|
GEP = RHSGEP;
|
|
Swapped = true;
|
|
} else if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(LHS)) {
|
|
// (ce_gep X, ...) - (gep X, ...)
|
|
if (CE->getOpcode() == Instruction::GetElementPtr &&
|
|
RHSGEP->getOperand(0) == CE->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
CstGEP = CE;
|
|
GEP = RHSGEP;
|
|
Swapped = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (GEP == 0)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Emit the offset of the GEP and an intptr_t.
|
|
Value *Result = EmitGEPOffset(GEP);
|
|
|
|
// If we had a constant expression GEP on the other side offsetting the
|
|
// pointer, subtract it from the offset we have.
|
|
if (CstGEP) {
|
|
Value *CstOffset = EmitGEPOffset(CstGEP);
|
|
Result = Builder->CreateSub(Result, CstOffset);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// If we have p - gep(p, ...) then we have to negate the result.
|
|
if (Swapped)
|
|
Result = Builder->CreateNeg(Result, "diff.neg");
|
|
|
|
return Builder->CreateIntCast(Result, Ty, true);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Op0 == Op1) // sub X, X -> 0
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A. This preserves NSW/NUW.
|
|
if (Value *V = dyn_castNegVal(Op1)) {
|
|
BinaryOperator *Res = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, V);
|
|
Res->setHasNoSignedWrap(I.hasNoSignedWrap());
|
|
Res->setHasNoUnsignedWrap(I.hasNoUnsignedWrap());
|
|
return Res;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // undef - X -> undef
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X - undef -> undef
|
|
if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(I.getContext()))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Op0, Op1);
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0)) {
|
|
// Replace (-1 - A) with (~A).
|
|
if (C->isAllOnesValue())
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Op1);
|
|
|
|
// C - ~X == X + (1+C)
|
|
Value *X = 0;
|
|
if (match(Op1, m_Not(m_Value(X))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(X, AddOne(C));
|
|
|
|
// -(X >>u 31) -> (X >>s 31)
|
|
// -(X >>s 31) -> (X >>u 31)
|
|
if (C->isZero()) {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
|
|
if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
|
|
SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
|
|
// Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert AShr.
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Instruction::AShr,
|
|
SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CU = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// Check to see if we are shifting out everything but the sign bit.
|
|
if (CU->getLimitedValue(SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) ==
|
|
SI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()-1) {
|
|
// Ok, the transformation is safe. Insert LShr.
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(
|
|
SI->getOperand(0), CU, SI->getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant sub into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
// C - zext(bool) -> bool ? C - 1 : C
|
|
if (ZExtInst *ZI = dyn_cast<ZExtInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (ZI->getSrcTy() == Type::getInt1Ty(I.getContext()))
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(ZI->getOperand(0), SubOne(C), C);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
|
|
if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
|
|
I.getName());
|
|
else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getName());
|
|
else if (ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I.getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CI2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
|
|
// C1-(X+C2) --> (C1-C2)-X
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
|
|
ConstantExpr::getSub(CI1, CI2), Op1I->getOperand(0));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Op1I->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// Replace (x - (y - z)) with (x + (z - y)) if the (y - z) subexpression
|
|
// is not used by anyone else...
|
|
//
|
|
if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
|
|
// Swap the two operands of the subexpr...
|
|
Value *IIOp0 = Op1I->getOperand(0), *IIOp1 = Op1I->getOperand(1);
|
|
Op1I->setOperand(0, IIOp1);
|
|
Op1I->setOperand(1, IIOp0);
|
|
|
|
// Create the new top level add instruction...
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0, Op1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Replace (A - (A & B)) with (A & ~B) if this is the only use of (A&B)...
|
|
//
|
|
if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
|
|
(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0 || Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0)) {
|
|
Value *OtherOp = Op1I->getOperand(Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0);
|
|
|
|
Value *NewNot = Builder->CreateNot(OtherOp, "B.not");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, NewNot);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// 0 - (X sdiv C) -> (X sdiv -C)
|
|
if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
|
|
if (CSI->isZero())
|
|
if (Constant *DivRHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1I->getOperand(1)))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Op1I->getOperand(0),
|
|
ConstantExpr::getNeg(DivRHS));
|
|
|
|
// X - X*C --> X * (1-C)
|
|
ConstantInt *C2 = 0;
|
|
if (dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1I, C2) == Op0) {
|
|
Constant *CP1 =
|
|
ConstantExpr::getSub(ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1),
|
|
C2);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0, CP1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
|
|
if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (Y+X)-Y == X
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(1));
|
|
else if (Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1) // (X+Y)-Y == X
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0I->getOperand(0));
|
|
} else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub) {
|
|
if (Op0I->getOperand(0) == Op1) // (X-Y)-X == -Y
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0I->getOperand(1),
|
|
I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ConstantInt *C1;
|
|
if (Value *X = dyn_castFoldableMul(Op0, C1)) {
|
|
if (X == Op1) // X*C - X --> X * (C-1)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op1, SubOne(C1));
|
|
|
|
ConstantInt *C2; // X*C1 - X*C2 -> X * (C1-C2)
|
|
if (X == dyn_castFoldableMul(Op1, C2))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(X, ConstantExpr::getSub(C1, C2));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Optimize pointer differences into the same array into a size. Consider:
|
|
// &A[10] - &A[0]: we should compile this to "10".
|
|
if (TD) {
|
|
Value *LHSOp, *RHSOp;
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_PtrToInt(m_Value(LHSOp))) &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_PtrToInt(m_Value(RHSOp))))
|
|
if (Value *Res = OptimizePointerDifference(LHSOp, RHSOp, I.getType()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Res);
|
|
|
|
// trunc(p)-trunc(q) -> trunc(p-q)
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_Trunc(m_PtrToInt(m_Value(LHSOp)))) &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_Trunc(m_PtrToInt(m_Value(RHSOp)))))
|
|
if (Value *Res = OptimizePointerDifference(LHSOp, RHSOp, I.getType()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Res);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFSub(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// If this is a 'B = x-(-A)', change to B = x+A...
|
|
if (Value *V = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFAdd(Op0, V);
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (Op1I->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd) {
|
|
if (Op1I->getOperand(0) == Op0) // X-(X+Y) == -Y
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(1),
|
|
I.getName());
|
|
else if (Op1I->getOperand(1) == Op0) // X-(Y+X) == -Y
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFNeg(Op1I->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) // undef * X -> 0
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS.
|
|
if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1C)) {
|
|
|
|
// ((X << C1)*C2) == (X * (C2 << C1))
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *SI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
|
|
if (SI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
|
|
if (Constant *ShOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(SI->getOperand(0),
|
|
ConstantExpr::getShl(CI, ShOp));
|
|
|
|
if (CI->isZero())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1C); // X * 0 == 0
|
|
if (CI->equalsInt(1)) // X * 1 == X
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
if (CI->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
|
|
|
|
const APInt& Val = cast<ConstantInt>(CI)->getValue();
|
|
if (Val.isPowerOf2()) { // Replace X*(2^C) with X << C
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), Val.logBase2()));
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1C->getType())) {
|
|
if (Op1C->isNullValue())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1C);
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1C)) {
|
|
if (Op1V->isAllOnesValue()) // X * -1 == 0 - X
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0, I.getName());
|
|
|
|
// As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
|
|
if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Splat))
|
|
if (CI->equalsInt(1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add && Op0I->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(Op1C)) {
|
|
// Canonicalize (X+C1)*C2 -> X*C2+C1*C2.
|
|
Value *Add = Builder->CreateMul(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1C, "tmp");
|
|
Value *C1C2 = Builder->CreateMul(Op1C, Op0I->getOperand(1));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Add, C1C2);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
|
|
if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(Op0v, Op1v);
|
|
|
|
// (X / Y) * Y = X - (X % Y)
|
|
// (X / Y) * -Y = (X % Y) - X
|
|
{
|
|
Value *Op1C = Op1;
|
|
BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
|
|
if (!BO ||
|
|
(BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::UDiv &&
|
|
BO->getOpcode() != Instruction::SDiv)) {
|
|
Op1C = Op0;
|
|
BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
|
|
}
|
|
Value *Neg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1C);
|
|
if (BO && BO->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
(BO->getOperand(1) == Op1C || BO->getOperand(1) == Neg) &&
|
|
(BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv ||
|
|
BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::SDiv)) {
|
|
Value *Op0BO = BO->getOperand(0), *Op1BO = BO->getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// If the division is exact, X % Y is zero.
|
|
if (SDivOperator *SDiv = dyn_cast<SDivOperator>(BO))
|
|
if (SDiv->isExact()) {
|
|
if (Op1BO == Op1C)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0BO);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0BO);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *Rem;
|
|
if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::UDiv)
|
|
Rem = Builder->CreateURem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
|
|
else
|
|
Rem = Builder->CreateSRem(Op0BO, Op1BO);
|
|
Rem->takeName(BO);
|
|
|
|
if (Op1BO == Op1C)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Op0BO, Rem);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(Rem, Op0BO);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// i1 mul -> i1 and.
|
|
if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(I.getContext()))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Op1);
|
|
|
|
// X*(1 << Y) --> X << Y
|
|
// (1 << Y)*X --> X << Y
|
|
{
|
|
Value *Y;
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op1, Y);
|
|
if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_One(), m_Value(Y))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateShl(Op0, Y);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If one of the operands of the multiply is a cast from a boolean value, then
|
|
// we know the bool is either zero or one, so this is a 'masking' multiply.
|
|
// X * Y (where Y is 0 or 1) -> X & (0-Y)
|
|
if (!isa<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
|
|
// -2 is "-1 << 1" so it is all bits set except the low one.
|
|
APInt Negative2(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), (uint64_t)-2, true);
|
|
|
|
Value *BoolCast = 0, *OtherOp = 0;
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Negative2))
|
|
BoolCast = Op0, OtherOp = Op1;
|
|
else if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Negative2))
|
|
BoolCast = Op1, OtherOp = Op0;
|
|
|
|
if (BoolCast) {
|
|
Value *V = Builder->CreateSub(Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
|
|
BoolCast, "tmp");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, OtherOp);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFMul(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// Simplify mul instructions with a constant RHS...
|
|
if (Constant *Op1C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (ConstantFP *Op1F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Op1C)) {
|
|
// "In IEEE floating point, x*1 is not equivalent to x for nans. However,
|
|
// ANSI says we can drop signals, so we can do this anyway." (from GCC)
|
|
if (Op1F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // Eliminate 'mul double %X, 1.0'
|
|
} else if (isa<VectorType>(Op1C->getType())) {
|
|
if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1C)) {
|
|
// As above, vector X*splat(1.0) -> X in all defined cases.
|
|
if (Constant *Splat = Op1V->getSplatValue()) {
|
|
if (ConstantFP *F = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(Splat))
|
|
if (F->isExactlyValue(1.0))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant mul into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Value *Op0v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op0)) // -X * -Y = X*Y
|
|
if (Value *Op1v = dyn_castFNegVal(Op1))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFMul(Op0v, Op1v);
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// SimplifyDivRemOfSelect - Try to fold a divide or remainder of a select
|
|
/// instruction.
|
|
bool InstCombiner::SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
SelectInst *SI = cast<SelectInst>(I.getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
// div/rem X, (Cond ? 0 : Y) -> div/rem X, Y
|
|
int NonNullOperand = -1;
|
|
if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (ST->isNullValue())
|
|
NonNullOperand = 2;
|
|
// div/rem X, (Cond ? Y : 0) -> div/rem X, Y
|
|
if (Constant *ST = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
|
|
if (ST->isNullValue())
|
|
NonNullOperand = 1;
|
|
|
|
if (NonNullOperand == -1)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
Value *SelectCond = SI->getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
// Change the div/rem to use 'Y' instead of the select.
|
|
I.setOperand(1, SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand));
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we know we replace the operand of the div/rem with 'Y' with no
|
|
// problem. However, the select, or the condition of the select may have
|
|
// multiple uses. Based on our knowledge that the operand must be non-zero,
|
|
// propagate the known value for the select into other uses of it, and
|
|
// propagate a known value of the condition into its other users.
|
|
|
|
// If the select and condition only have a single use, don't bother with this,
|
|
// early exit.
|
|
if (SI->use_empty() && SelectCond->hasOneUse())
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Scan the current block backward, looking for other uses of SI.
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &I, BBFront = I.getParent()->begin();
|
|
|
|
while (BBI != BBFront) {
|
|
--BBI;
|
|
// If we found a call to a function, we can't assume it will return, so
|
|
// information from below it cannot be propagated above it.
|
|
if (isa<CallInst>(BBI) && !isa<IntrinsicInst>(BBI))
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
// Replace uses of the select or its condition with the known values.
|
|
for (Instruction::op_iterator I = BBI->op_begin(), E = BBI->op_end();
|
|
I != E; ++I) {
|
|
if (*I == SI) {
|
|
*I = SI->getOperand(NonNullOperand);
|
|
Worklist.Add(BBI);
|
|
} else if (*I == SelectCond) {
|
|
*I = NonNullOperand == 1 ? ConstantInt::getTrue(BBI->getContext()) :
|
|
ConstantInt::getFalse(BBI->getContext());
|
|
Worklist.Add(BBI);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we past the instruction, quit looking for it.
|
|
if (&*BBI == SI)
|
|
SI = 0;
|
|
if (&*BBI == SelectCond)
|
|
SelectCond = 0;
|
|
|
|
// If we ran out of things to eliminate, break out of the loop.
|
|
if (SelectCond == 0 && SI == 0)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// This function implements the transforms on div instructions that work
|
|
/// regardless of the kind of div instruction it is (udiv, sdiv, or fdiv). It is
|
|
/// used by the visitors to those instructions.
|
|
/// @brief Transforms common to all three div instructions
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::commonDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// undef / X -> 0 for integer.
|
|
// undef / X -> undef for FP (the undef could be a snan).
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (Op0->getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// X / undef -> undef
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1);
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer division
|
|
/// instructions (udiv and sdiv). It is called by the visitors to those integer
|
|
/// division instructions.
|
|
/// @brief Common integer divide transforms
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIDivTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// (sdiv X, X) --> 1 (udiv X, X) --> 1
|
|
if (Op0 == Op1) {
|
|
if (const VectorType *Ty = dyn_cast<VectorType>(I.getType())) {
|
|
Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(Ty->getElementType(), 1);
|
|
std::vector<Constant*> Elts(Ty->getNumElements(), CI);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Constant *CI = ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *Common = commonDivTransforms(I))
|
|
return Common;
|
|
|
|
// Handle cases involving: [su]div X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
|
|
// This does not apply for fdiv.
|
|
if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
// div X, 1 == X
|
|
if (RHS->equalsInt(1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
|
|
// (X / C1) / C2 -> X / (C1*C2)
|
|
if (Instruction *LHS = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction::BinaryOps(LHS->getOpcode()) == I.getOpcode())
|
|
if (ConstantInt *LHSRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(LHS->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (MultiplyOverflows(RHS, LHSRHS,
|
|
I.getOpcode()==Instruction::SDiv))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
else
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), LHS->getOperand(0),
|
|
ConstantExpr::getMul(RHS, LHSRHS));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!RHS->isZero()) { // avoid X udiv 0
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// 0 / X == 0, we don't need to preserve faults!
|
|
if (ConstantInt *LHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
|
|
if (LHS->equalsInt(0))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// It can't be division by zero, hence it must be division by one.
|
|
if (I.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(I.getContext()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantVector *Op1V = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *X = cast_or_null<ConstantInt>(Op1V->getSplatValue()))
|
|
// div X, 1 == X
|
|
if (X->isOne())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitUDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// Handle the integer div common cases
|
|
if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
|
|
return Common;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
// X udiv C^2 -> X >> C
|
|
// Check to see if this is an unsigned division with an exact power of 2,
|
|
// if so, convert to a right shift.
|
|
if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2()) // 0 not included in isPowerOf2
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), C->getValue().logBase2()));
|
|
|
|
// X udiv C, where C >= signbit
|
|
if (C->getValue().isNegative()) {
|
|
Value *IC = Builder->CreateICmpULT( Op0, C);
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(IC, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()),
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// X udiv (C1 << N), where C1 is "1<<C2" --> X >> (N+C2)
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *RHSI = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
const APInt& C1 = cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue();
|
|
if (C1.isPowerOf2()) {
|
|
Value *N = RHSI->getOperand(1);
|
|
const Type *NTy = N->getType();
|
|
if (uint32_t C2 = C1.logBase2())
|
|
N = Builder->CreateAdd(N, ConstantInt::get(NTy, C2), "tmp");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, N);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// udiv X, (Select Cond, C1, C2) --> Select Cond, (shr X, C1), (shr X, C2)
|
|
// where C1&C2 are powers of two.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
const APInt &TVA = STO->getValue(), &FVA = SFO->getValue();
|
|
if (TVA.isPowerOf2() && FVA.isPowerOf2()) {
|
|
// Compute the shift amounts
|
|
uint32_t TSA = TVA.logBase2(), FSA = FVA.logBase2();
|
|
// Construct the "on true" case of the select
|
|
Constant *TC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), TSA);
|
|
Value *TSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, TC, SI->getName()+".t");
|
|
|
|
// Construct the "on false" case of the select
|
|
Constant *FC = ConstantInt::get(Op0->getType(), FSA);
|
|
Value *FSI = Builder->CreateLShr(Op0, FC, SI->getName()+".f");
|
|
|
|
// construct the select instruction and return it.
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TSI, FSI, SI->getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// Handle the integer div common cases
|
|
if (Instruction *Common = commonIDivTransforms(I))
|
|
return Common;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
// sdiv X, -1 == -X
|
|
if (RHS->isAllOnesValue())
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(Op0);
|
|
|
|
// sdiv X, C --> ashr X, log2(C)
|
|
if (cast<SDivOperator>(&I)->isExact() &&
|
|
RHS->getValue().isNonNegative() &&
|
|
RHS->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
|
|
Value *ShAmt = llvm::ConstantInt::get(RHS->getType(),
|
|
RHS->getValue().exactLogBase2());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(Op0, ShAmt, I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// -X/C --> X/-C provided the negation doesn't overflow.
|
|
if (SubOperator *Sub = dyn_cast<SubOperator>(Op0))
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0)) &&
|
|
cast<Constant>(Sub->getOperand(0))->isNullValue() &&
|
|
Sub->hasNoSignedWrap())
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSDiv(Sub->getOperand(1),
|
|
ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
|
|
// unsigned inputs), turn this into a udiv.
|
|
if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask)) {
|
|
// X sdiv Y -> X udiv Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
ConstantInt *ShiftedInt;
|
|
if (match(Op1, m_Shl(m_ConstantInt(ShiftedInt), m_Value())) &&
|
|
ShiftedInt->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
|
|
// X sdiv (1 << Y) -> X udiv (1 << Y) ( -> X u>> Y)
|
|
// Safe because the only negative value (1 << Y) can take on is
|
|
// INT_MIN, and X sdiv INT_MIN == X udiv INT_MIN == 0 if X doesn't have
|
|
// the sign bit set.
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateUDiv(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFDiv(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
return commonDivTransforms(I);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// This function implements the transforms on rem instructions that work
|
|
/// regardless of the kind of rem instruction it is (urem, srem, or frem). It
|
|
/// is used by the visitors to those instructions.
|
|
/// @brief Transforms common to all three rem instructions
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::commonRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) { // undef % X -> 0
|
|
if (I.getType()->isFPOrFPVector())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X % undef -> undef (could be SNaN)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X % undef -> undef
|
|
|
|
// Handle cases involving: rem X, (select Cond, Y, Z)
|
|
if (isa<SelectInst>(Op1) && SimplifyDivRemOfSelect(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// This function implements the transforms common to both integer remainder
|
|
/// instructions (urem and srem). It is called by the visitors to those integer
|
|
/// remainder instructions.
|
|
/// @brief Common integer remainder transforms
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::commonIRemTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *common = commonRemTransforms(I))
|
|
return common;
|
|
|
|
// 0 % X == 0 for integer, we don't need to preserve faults!
|
|
if (Constant *LHS = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0))
|
|
if (LHS->isNullValue())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
// X % 0 == undef, we don't need to preserve faults!
|
|
if (RHS->equalsInt(0))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, UndefValue::get(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (RHS->equalsInt(1)) // X % 1 == 0
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *Op0I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0I)) {
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
} else if (isa<PHINode>(Op0I)) {
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we can fold away this rem instruction.
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitURem(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
|
|
return common;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
// X urem C^2 -> X and C
|
|
// Check to see if this is an unsigned remainder with an exact power of 2,
|
|
// if so, convert to a bitwise and.
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHS))
|
|
if (C->getValue().isPowerOf2())
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(C));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *RHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(I.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// Turn A % (C << N), where C is 2^k, into A & ((C << N)-1)
|
|
if (RHSI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (cast<ConstantInt>(RHSI->getOperand(0))->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
|
|
Constant *N1 = Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType());
|
|
Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(RHSI, N1, "tmp");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0, Add);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// urem X, (select Cond, 2^C1, 2^C2) --> select Cond, (and X, C1), (and X, C2)
|
|
// where C1&C2 are powers of two.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *STO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (ConstantInt *SFO = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
// STO == 0 and SFO == 0 handled above.
|
|
if ((STO->getValue().isPowerOf2()) &&
|
|
(SFO->getValue().isPowerOf2())) {
|
|
Value *TrueAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(STO),
|
|
SI->getName()+".t");
|
|
Value *FalseAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0, SubOne(SFO),
|
|
SI->getName()+".f");
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(SI->getOperand(0), TrueAnd, FalseAnd);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// Handle the integer rem common cases
|
|
if (Instruction *Common = commonIRemTransforms(I))
|
|
return Common;
|
|
|
|
if (Value *RHSNeg = dyn_castNegVal(Op1))
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(RHSNeg) ||
|
|
(isa<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg) &&
|
|
cast<ConstantInt>(RHSNeg)->getValue().isStrictlyPositive())) {
|
|
// X % -Y -> X % Y
|
|
Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
|
|
I.setOperand(1, RHSNeg);
|
|
return &I;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the sign bits of both operands are zero (i.e. we can prove they are
|
|
// unsigned inputs), turn this into a urem.
|
|
if (I.getType()->isInteger()) {
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()));
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, Mask) && MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, Mask)) {
|
|
// X srem Y -> X urem Y, iff X and Y don't have sign bit set
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateURem(Op0, Op1, I.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If it's a constant vector, flip any negative values positive.
|
|
if (ConstantVector *RHSV = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(Op1)) {
|
|
unsigned VWidth = RHSV->getNumOperands();
|
|
|
|
bool hasNegative = false;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; !hasNegative && i != VWidth; ++i)
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i)))
|
|
if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
|
|
hasNegative = true;
|
|
|
|
if (hasNegative) {
|
|
std::vector<Constant *> Elts(VWidth);
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != VWidth; ++i) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(RHSV->getOperand(i))) {
|
|
if (RHS->getValue().isNegative())
|
|
Elts[i] = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(RHS));
|
|
else
|
|
Elts[i] = RHS;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Constant *NewRHSV = ConstantVector::get(Elts);
|
|
if (NewRHSV != RHSV) {
|
|
Worklist.AddValue(I.getOperand(1));
|
|
I.setOperand(1, NewRHSV);
|
|
return &I;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFRem(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
return commonRemTransforms(I);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// isOneBitSet - Return true if there is exactly one bit set in the specified
|
|
// constant.
|
|
static bool isOneBitSet(const ConstantInt *CI) {
|
|
return CI->getValue().isPowerOf2();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// getICmpCode - Encode a icmp predicate into a three bit mask. These bits
|
|
/// are carefully arranged to allow folding of expressions such as:
|
|
///
|
|
/// (A < B) | (A > B) --> (A != B)
|
|
///
|
|
/// Note that this is only valid if the first and second predicates have the
|
|
/// same sign. Is illegal to do: (A u< B) | (A s> B)
|
|
///
|
|
/// Three bits are used to represent the condition, as follows:
|
|
/// 0 A > B
|
|
/// 1 A == B
|
|
/// 2 A < B
|
|
///
|
|
/// <=> Value Definition
|
|
/// 000 0 Always false
|
|
/// 001 1 A > B
|
|
/// 010 2 A == B
|
|
/// 011 3 A >= B
|
|
/// 100 4 A < B
|
|
/// 101 5 A != B
|
|
/// 110 6 A <= B
|
|
/// 111 7 Always true
|
|
///
|
|
static unsigned getICmpCode(const ICmpInst *ICI) {
|
|
switch (ICI->getPredicate()) {
|
|
// False -> 0
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: return 1; // 001
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: return 2; // 010
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE: return 3; // 011
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: return 4; // 100
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: return 5; // 101
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE: return 6; // 110
|
|
// True -> 7
|
|
default:
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Invalid ICmp predicate!");
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// getFCmpCode - Similar to getICmpCode but for FCmpInst. This encodes a fcmp
|
|
/// predicate into a three bit mask. It also returns whether it is an ordered
|
|
/// predicate by reference.
|
|
static unsigned getFCmpCode(FCmpInst::Predicate CC, bool &isOrdered) {
|
|
isOrdered = false;
|
|
switch (CC) {
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD: isOrdered = true; return 0; // 000
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO: return 0; // 000
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT: isOrdered = true; return 1; // 001
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT: return 1; // 001
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ: isOrdered = true; return 2; // 010
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ: return 2; // 010
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE: isOrdered = true; return 3; // 011
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE: return 3; // 011
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT: isOrdered = true; return 4; // 100
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT: return 4; // 100
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE: isOrdered = true; return 5; // 101
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE: return 5; // 101
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE: isOrdered = true; return 6; // 110
|
|
case FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE: return 6; // 110
|
|
// True -> 7
|
|
default:
|
|
// Not expecting FCMP_FALSE and FCMP_TRUE;
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Unexpected FCmp predicate!");
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// getICmpValue - This is the complement of getICmpCode, which turns an
|
|
/// opcode and two operands into either a constant true or false, or a brand
|
|
/// new ICmp instruction. The sign is passed in to determine which kind
|
|
/// of predicate to use in the new icmp instruction.
|
|
static Value *getICmpValue(bool sign, unsigned code, Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
|
|
switch (code) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal ICmp code!");
|
|
case 0: return ConstantInt::getFalse(LHS->getContext());
|
|
case 1:
|
|
if (sign)
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 2: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 3:
|
|
if (sign)
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 4:
|
|
if (sign)
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 5: return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 6:
|
|
if (sign)
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(LHS->getContext());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// getFCmpValue - This is the complement of getFCmpCode, which turns an
|
|
/// opcode and two operands into either a FCmp instruction. isordered is passed
|
|
/// in to determine which kind of predicate to use in the new fcmp instruction.
|
|
static Value *getFCmpValue(bool isordered, unsigned code,
|
|
Value *LHS, Value *RHS) {
|
|
switch (code) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal FCmp code!");
|
|
case 0:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 1:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 2:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UEQ, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 3:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UGE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 4:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULT, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 5:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 6:
|
|
if (isordered)
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
else
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ULE, LHS, RHS);
|
|
case 7: return ConstantInt::getTrue(LHS->getContext());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// PredicatesFoldable - Return true if both predicates match sign or if at
|
|
/// least one of them is an equality comparison (which is signless).
|
|
static bool PredicatesFoldable(ICmpInst::Predicate p1, ICmpInst::Predicate p2) {
|
|
return (CmpInst::isSigned(p1) == CmpInst::isSigned(p2)) ||
|
|
(CmpInst::isSigned(p1) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p2)) ||
|
|
(CmpInst::isSigned(p2) && ICmpInst::isEquality(p1));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
namespace {
|
|
// FoldICmpLogical - Implements (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
|
|
struct FoldICmpLogical {
|
|
InstCombiner &IC;
|
|
Value *LHS, *RHS;
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate pred;
|
|
FoldICmpLogical(InstCombiner &ic, ICmpInst *ICI)
|
|
: IC(ic), LHS(ICI->getOperand(0)), RHS(ICI->getOperand(1)),
|
|
pred(ICI->getPredicate()) {}
|
|
bool shouldApply(Value *V) const {
|
|
if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(V))
|
|
if (PredicatesFoldable(pred, ICI->getPredicate()))
|
|
return ((ICI->getOperand(0) == LHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == RHS) ||
|
|
(ICI->getOperand(0) == RHS && ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS));
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
Instruction *apply(Instruction &Log) const {
|
|
ICmpInst *ICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(0));
|
|
if (ICI->getOperand(0) != LHS) {
|
|
assert(ICI->getOperand(1) == LHS);
|
|
ICI->swapOperands(); // Swap the LHS and RHS of the ICmp
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
ICmpInst *RHSICI = cast<ICmpInst>(Log.getOperand(1));
|
|
unsigned LHSCode = getICmpCode(ICI);
|
|
unsigned RHSCode = getICmpCode(RHSICI);
|
|
unsigned Code;
|
|
switch (Log.getOpcode()) {
|
|
case Instruction::And: Code = LHSCode & RHSCode; break;
|
|
case Instruction::Or: Code = LHSCode | RHSCode; break;
|
|
case Instruction::Xor: Code = LHSCode ^ RHSCode; break;
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Illegal logical opcode!"); return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool isSigned = RHSICI->isSigned() || ICI->isSigned();
|
|
Value *RV = getICmpValue(isSigned, Code, LHS, RHS);
|
|
if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
|
|
return I;
|
|
// Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
|
|
return IC.ReplaceInstUsesWith(Log, RV);
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
} // end anonymous namespace
|
|
|
|
// OptAndOp - This handles expressions of the form ((val OP C1) & C2). Where
|
|
// the Op parameter is 'OP', OpRHS is 'C1', and AndRHS is 'C2'. Op is
|
|
// guaranteed to be a binary operator.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::OptAndOp(Instruction *Op,
|
|
ConstantInt *OpRHS,
|
|
ConstantInt *AndRHS,
|
|
BinaryOperator &TheAnd) {
|
|
Value *X = Op->getOperand(0);
|
|
Constant *Together = 0;
|
|
if (!Op->isShift())
|
|
Together = ConstantExpr::getAnd(AndRHS, OpRHS);
|
|
|
|
switch (Op->getOpcode()) {
|
|
case Instruction::Xor:
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// (X ^ C1) & C2 --> (X & C2) ^ (C1&C2)
|
|
Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
|
|
And->takeName(Op);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(And, Together);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
if (Together == AndRHS) // (X | C) & C --> C
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, AndRHS);
|
|
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse() && Together != OpRHS) {
|
|
// (X | C1) & C2 --> (X | (C1&C2)) & C2
|
|
Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, Together);
|
|
Or->takeName(Op);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or, AndRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Instruction::Add:
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// Adding a one to a single bit bit-field should be turned into an XOR
|
|
// of the bit. First thing to check is to see if this AND is with a
|
|
// single bit constant.
|
|
const APInt& AndRHSV = cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS)->getValue();
|
|
|
|
// If there is only one bit set...
|
|
if (isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(AndRHS))) {
|
|
// Ok, at this point, we know that we are masking the result of the
|
|
// ADD down to exactly one bit. If the constant we are adding has
|
|
// no bits set below this bit, then we can eliminate the ADD.
|
|
const APInt& AddRHS = cast<ConstantInt>(OpRHS)->getValue();
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if any bits below the one bit set in AndRHSV are set.
|
|
if ((AddRHS & (AndRHSV-1)) == 0) {
|
|
// If not, the only thing that can effect the output of the AND is
|
|
// the bit specified by AndRHSV. If that bit is set, the effect of
|
|
// the XOR is to toggle the bit. If it is clear, then the ADD has
|
|
// no effect.
|
|
if ((AddRHS & AndRHSV) == 0) { // Bit is not set, noop
|
|
TheAnd.setOperand(0, X);
|
|
return &TheAnd;
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Pull the XOR out of the AND.
|
|
Value *NewAnd = Builder->CreateAnd(X, AndRHS);
|
|
NewAnd->takeName(Op);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NewAnd, AndRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Instruction::Shl: {
|
|
// We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
|
|
// the anded constant includes them, clear them now!
|
|
//
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
|
|
uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
|
|
APInt ShlMask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth-OpRHSVal));
|
|
ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(AndRHS->getContext(),
|
|
AndRHS->getValue() & ShlMask);
|
|
|
|
if (CI->getValue() == ShlMask) {
|
|
// Masking out bits that the shift already masks
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op); // No need for the and.
|
|
} else if (CI != AndRHS) { // Reducing bits set in and.
|
|
TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI);
|
|
return &TheAnd;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
case Instruction::LShr: {
|
|
// We know that the AND will not produce any of the bits shifted in, so if
|
|
// the anded constant includes them, clear them now! This only applies to
|
|
// unsigned shifts, because a signed shr may bring in set bits!
|
|
//
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
|
|
uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
|
|
APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
|
|
ConstantInt *CI = ConstantInt::get(Op->getContext(),
|
|
AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
|
|
|
|
if (CI->getValue() == ShrMask) {
|
|
// Masking out bits that the shift already masks.
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(TheAnd, Op);
|
|
} else if (CI != AndRHS) {
|
|
TheAnd.setOperand(1, CI); // Reduce bits set in and cst.
|
|
return &TheAnd;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
case Instruction::AShr:
|
|
// Signed shr.
|
|
// See if this is shifting in some sign extension, then masking it out
|
|
// with an and.
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHS->getType()->getBitWidth();
|
|
uint32_t OpRHSVal = OpRHS->getLimitedValue(BitWidth);
|
|
APInt ShrMask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - OpRHSVal));
|
|
Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(Op->getContext(),
|
|
AndRHS->getValue() & ShrMask);
|
|
if (C == AndRHS) { // Masking out bits shifted in.
|
|
// (Val ashr C1) & C2 -> (Val lshr C1) & C2
|
|
// Make the argument unsigned.
|
|
Value *ShVal = Op->getOperand(0);
|
|
ShVal = Builder->CreateLShr(ShVal, OpRHS, Op->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(ShVal, AndRHS, TheAnd.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// InsertRangeTest - Emit a computation of: (V >= Lo && V < Hi) if Inside is
|
|
/// true, otherwise (V < Lo || V >= Hi). In pratice, we emit the more efficient
|
|
/// (V-Lo) <u Hi-Lo. This method expects that Lo <= Hi. isSigned indicates
|
|
/// whether to treat the V, Lo and HI as signed or not. IB is the location to
|
|
/// insert new instructions.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::InsertRangeTest(Value *V, Constant *Lo, Constant *Hi,
|
|
bool isSigned, bool Inside,
|
|
Instruction &IB) {
|
|
assert(cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getICmp((isSigned ?
|
|
ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE:ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE), Lo, Hi))->getZExtValue() &&
|
|
"Lo is not <= Hi in range emission code!");
|
|
|
|
if (Inside) {
|
|
if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially false.
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_NE, V, V);
|
|
|
|
// V >= Min && V < Hi --> V < Hi
|
|
if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
|
|
ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT : ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Emit V-Lo <u Hi-Lo
|
|
Constant *NegLo = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo);
|
|
Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
|
|
Constant *UpperBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, UpperBound);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Lo == Hi) // Trivially true.
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ, V, V);
|
|
|
|
// V < Min || V >= Hi -> V > Hi-1
|
|
Hi = SubOne(cast<ConstantInt>(Hi));
|
|
if (cast<ConstantInt>(Lo)->isMinValue(isSigned)) {
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate pred = (isSigned ?
|
|
ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT : ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(pred, V, Hi);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Emit V-Lo >u Hi-1-Lo
|
|
// Note that Hi has already had one subtracted from it, above.
|
|
ConstantInt *NegLo = cast<ConstantInt>(ConstantExpr::getNeg(Lo));
|
|
Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(V, NegLo, V->getName()+".off");
|
|
Constant *LowerBound = ConstantExpr::getAdd(NegLo, Hi);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add, LowerBound);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// isRunOfOnes - Returns true iff Val consists of one contiguous run of 1s with
|
|
// any number of 0s on either side. The 1s are allowed to wrap from LSB to
|
|
// MSB, so 0x000FFF0, 0x0000FFFF, and 0xFF0000FF are all runs. 0x0F0F0000 is
|
|
// not, since all 1s are not contiguous.
|
|
static bool isRunOfOnes(ConstantInt *Val, uint32_t &MB, uint32_t &ME) {
|
|
const APInt& V = Val->getValue();
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = Val->getType()->getBitWidth();
|
|
if (!APIntOps::isShiftedMask(BitWidth, V)) return false;
|
|
|
|
// look for the first zero bit after the run of ones
|
|
MB = BitWidth - ((V - 1) ^ V).countLeadingZeros();
|
|
// look for the first non-zero bit
|
|
ME = V.getActiveBits();
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldLogicalPlusAnd - This is part of an expression (LHS +/- RHS) & Mask,
|
|
/// where isSub determines whether the operator is a sub. If we can fold one of
|
|
/// the following xforms:
|
|
///
|
|
/// ((A & N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == Mask
|
|
/// ((A | N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
|
|
/// ((A ^ N) +/- B) & Mask -> (A +/- B) & Mask iff N&Mask == 0
|
|
///
|
|
/// return (A +/- B).
|
|
///
|
|
Value *InstCombiner::FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
|
|
ConstantInt *Mask, bool isSub,
|
|
Instruction &I) {
|
|
Instruction *LHSI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(LHS);
|
|
if (!LHSI || LHSI->getNumOperands() != 2 ||
|
|
!isa<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1))) return 0;
|
|
|
|
ConstantInt *N = cast<ConstantInt>(LHSI->getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
switch (LHSI->getOpcode()) {
|
|
default: return 0;
|
|
case Instruction::And:
|
|
if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask) == Mask) {
|
|
// If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), this is simple.
|
|
if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
|
|
Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) ==
|
|
Mask->getValue().getBitWidth())
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, if Mask is 0+1+0+, and if B is known to have the low 0+
|
|
// part, we don't need any explicit masks to take them out of A. If that
|
|
// is all N is, ignore it.
|
|
uint32_t MB = 0, ME = 0;
|
|
if (isRunOfOnes(Mask, MB, ME)) { // begin/end bit of run, inclusive
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = cast<IntegerType>(RHS->getType())->getBitWidth();
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, MB-1));
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(RHS, Mask))
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
case Instruction::Xor:
|
|
// If the AndRHS is a power of two minus one (0+1+), and N&Mask == 0
|
|
if ((Mask->getValue().countLeadingZeros() +
|
|
Mask->getValue().countPopulation()) == Mask->getValue().getBitWidth()
|
|
&& ConstantExpr::getAnd(N, Mask)->isNullValue())
|
|
break;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isSub)
|
|
return Builder->CreateSub(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
|
|
return Builder->CreateAdd(LHSI->getOperand(0), RHS, "fold");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldAndOfICmps - Fold (icmp)&(icmp) if possible.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfICmps(Instruction &I,
|
|
ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
|
|
Value *Val, *Val2;
|
|
ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
|
|
|
|
// This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 B, C2).
|
|
if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val),
|
|
m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
|
|
!match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2),
|
|
m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC) {
|
|
// (icmp ult A, C) & (icmp ult B, C) --> (icmp ult (A|B), C)
|
|
// where C is a power of 2
|
|
if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT &&
|
|
LHSCst->getValue().isPowerOf2()) {
|
|
Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (icmp eq A, 0) & (icmp eq B, 0) --> (icmp eq (A|B), 0)
|
|
if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ && LHSCst->isZero()) {
|
|
Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// From here on, we only handle:
|
|
// (icmp1 A, C1) & (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
|
|
if (Val != Val2) return 0;
|
|
|
|
// ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
|
|
if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
|
|
RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
|
|
LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
|
|
RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// We can't fold (ugt x, C) & (sgt x, C2).
|
|
if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
|
|
bool ShouldSwap;
|
|
if (CmpInst::isSigned(LHSCC) ||
|
|
(ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
|
|
CmpInst::isSigned(RHSCC)))
|
|
ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
|
|
else
|
|
ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
|
|
|
|
if (ShouldSwap) {
|
|
std::swap(LHS, RHS);
|
|
std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
|
|
std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
|
|
// comparing a value against two constants and and'ing the result
|
|
// together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
|
|
// icmp eq, icmp ne, icmp [su]lt, and icmp [SU]gt here. We also know
|
|
// (from the FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants
|
|
// are not equal and that the larger constant is on the RHS
|
|
assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
|
|
|
|
switch (LHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X == 13 & X == 15) -> false
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 & X > 15) -> false
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(I.getContext()));
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 & X != 15) -> X == 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 & X < 15) -> X == 13
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
}
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
|
|
if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X u< 14) -> X < 13
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Val, LHSCst);
|
|
break; // (X != 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
|
|
if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) // (X != 13 & X s< 14) -> X < 13
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT, Val, LHSCst);
|
|
break; // (X != 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
|
|
if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)){// (X != 13 & X != 14) -> X-13 >u 1
|
|
Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
|
|
Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT, Add,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Add->getType(), 1));
|
|
}
|
|
break; // (X != 13 & X != 15) -> no change
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 & X == 15) -> false
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 & X u> 15) -> false
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(I.getContext()));
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 & X != 15) -> X u< 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 & X u< 15) -> X u< 13
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 & X == 15) -> false
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 & X s> 15) -> false
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(I.getContext()));
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 & X != 15) -> X < 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 & X s< 15) -> X < 13
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 & X u> 15) -> X u> 15
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 & X s> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
|
|
if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X u> 13 & X != 14) -> X u> 14
|
|
return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
|
|
break; // (X u> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 & X u< 15) -> (X-14) <u 1
|
|
return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
|
|
RHSCst, false, true, I);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 & X s< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 & X == 15) -> X == 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 & X s> 15) -> X s> 15
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 & X u> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
|
|
if (RHSCst == AddOne(LHSCst)) // (X s> 13 & X != 14) -> X s> 14
|
|
return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, Val, RHSCst);
|
|
break; // (X s> 13 & X != 15) -> no change
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 & X s< 15) -> (X-14) s< 1
|
|
return InsertRangeTest(Val, AddOne(LHSCst),
|
|
RHSCst, true, true, I);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 & X u< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldAndOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
|
|
FCmpInst *RHS) {
|
|
|
|
if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD &&
|
|
RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD) {
|
|
// (fcmp ord x, c) & (fcmp ord y, c) -> (fcmp ord x, y)
|
|
if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
|
|
// false.
|
|
if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(I.getContext()));
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
|
|
LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
|
|
// "fcmp ord x,x" is "fcmp ord x, 0".
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_ORD,
|
|
LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
|
|
FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
|
|
// Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
|
|
Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
|
|
std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
|
|
// Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) & (fcmp cc1 x, y).
|
|
if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
|
|
return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
|
|
|
|
if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(I.getContext()));
|
|
if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
|
|
bool Op0Ordered;
|
|
bool Op1Ordered;
|
|
unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
|
|
unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
|
|
if (Op1Pred == 0) {
|
|
std::swap(LHS, RHS);
|
|
std::swap(Op0Pred, Op1Pred);
|
|
std::swap(Op0Ordered, Op1Ordered);
|
|
}
|
|
if (Op0Pred == 0) {
|
|
// uno && ueq -> uno && (uno || eq) -> ueq
|
|
// ord && olt -> ord && (ord && lt) -> olt
|
|
if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
|
|
// uno && oeq -> uno && (ord && eq) -> false
|
|
// uno && ord -> false
|
|
if (!Op0Ordered)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getFalse(I.getContext()));
|
|
// ord && ueq -> ord && (uno || eq) -> oeq
|
|
return cast<Instruction>(getFCmpValue(true, Op1Pred, Op0LHS, Op0RHS));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAnd(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Value *V = SimplifyAndInst(Op0, Op1, TD))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
|
|
|
|
// See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
|
|
// purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *AndRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
const APInt &AndRHSMask = AndRHS->getValue();
|
|
APInt NotAndRHS(~AndRHSMask);
|
|
|
|
// Optimize a variety of ((val OP C1) & C2) combinations...
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
|
|
Value *Op0LHS = Op0I->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *Op0RHS = Op0I->getOperand(1);
|
|
switch (Op0I->getOpcode()) {
|
|
default: break;
|
|
case Instruction::Xor:
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
// If the mask is only needed on one incoming arm, push it up.
|
|
if (!Op0I->hasOneUse()) break;
|
|
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, NotAndRHS)) {
|
|
// Not masking anything out for the LHS, move to RHS.
|
|
Value *NewRHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0RHS, AndRHS,
|
|
Op0RHS->getName()+".masked");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0I->getOpcode(), Op0LHS, NewRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(Op0RHS) &&
|
|
MaskedValueIsZero(Op0RHS, NotAndRHS)) {
|
|
// Not masking anything out for the RHS, move to LHS.
|
|
Value *NewLHS = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0LHS, AndRHS,
|
|
Op0LHS->getName()+".masked");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0I->getOpcode(), NewLHS, Op0RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
case Instruction::Add:
|
|
// ((A & N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
|
|
// ((A | N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
|
|
// ((A ^ N) + B) & AndRHS -> (A + B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
|
|
if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, false, I))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
|
|
if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0RHS, Op0LHS, AndRHS, false, I))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS); // Add commutes
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Instruction::Sub:
|
|
// ((A & N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == AndRHS.
|
|
// ((A | N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
|
|
// ((A ^ N) - B) & AndRHS -> (A - B) & AndRHS iff N&AndRHS == 0
|
|
if (Value *V = FoldLogicalPlusAnd(Op0LHS, Op0RHS, AndRHS, true, I))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V, AndRHS);
|
|
|
|
// (A - N) & AndRHS -> -N & AndRHS iff A&AndRHS==0 and AndRHS
|
|
// has 1's for all bits that the subtraction with A might affect.
|
|
if (Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = AndRHSMask.getBitWidth();
|
|
uint32_t Zeros = AndRHSMask.countLeadingZeros();
|
|
APInt Mask = APInt::getLowBitsSet(BitWidth, BitWidth - Zeros);
|
|
|
|
ConstantInt *A = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0LHS);
|
|
if (!(A && A->isZero()) && // avoid infinite recursion.
|
|
MaskedValueIsZero(Op0LHS, Mask)) {
|
|
Value *NewNeg = Builder->CreateNeg(Op0RHS);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewNeg, AndRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Instruction::Shl:
|
|
case Instruction::LShr:
|
|
// (1 << x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
|
|
// (1 >> x) & 1 --> zext(x == 0)
|
|
if (AndRHSMask == 1 && Op0LHS == AndRHS) {
|
|
Value *NewICmp =
|
|
Builder->CreateICmpEQ(Op0RHS, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
return new ZExtInst(NewICmp, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = OptAndOp(Op0I, Op0CI, AndRHS, I))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
} else if (CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
|
|
// If this is an integer truncation or change from signed-to-unsigned, and
|
|
// if the source is an and/or with immediate, transform it. This
|
|
// frequently occurs for bitfield accesses.
|
|
if (Instruction *CastOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(CI->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if ((isa<TruncInst>(CI) || isa<BitCastInst>(CI)) &&
|
|
CastOp->getNumOperands() == 2)
|
|
if (ConstantInt *AndCI =dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CastOp->getOperand(1))){
|
|
if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::And) {
|
|
// Change: and (cast (and X, C1) to T), C2
|
|
// into : and (cast X to T), trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
|
|
// This will fold the two constants together, which may allow
|
|
// other simplifications.
|
|
Value *NewCast = Builder->CreateTruncOrBitCast(
|
|
CastOp->getOperand(0), I.getType(),
|
|
CastOp->getName()+".shrunk");
|
|
// trunc_or_bitcast(C1)&C2
|
|
Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
|
|
C3 = ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewCast, C3);
|
|
} else if (CastOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
|
|
// Change: and (cast (or X, C1) to T), C2
|
|
// into : trunc(C1)&C2 iff trunc(C1)&C2 == C2
|
|
Constant *C3 = ConstantExpr::getTruncOrBitCast(AndCI,I.getType());
|
|
if (ConstantExpr::getAnd(C3, AndRHS) == AndRHS)
|
|
// trunc(C1)&C2
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, AndRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// (~A & ~B) == (~(A | B)) - De Morgan's Law
|
|
if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0))
|
|
if (Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1))
|
|
if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
|
|
I.getName()+".demorgan");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(Or);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
Value *A = 0, *B = 0, *C = 0, *D = 0;
|
|
// (A|B) & ~(A&B) -> A^B
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) &&
|
|
((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C)))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
|
|
|
|
// ~(A&B) & (A|B) -> A^B
|
|
if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
match(Op0, m_Not(m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) &&
|
|
((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C)))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
|
|
|
|
if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
|
|
if (A == Op1) { // (A^B)&A -> A&(A^B)
|
|
I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
|
|
std::swap(Op0, Op1);
|
|
} else if (B == Op1) { // (A^B)&B -> B&(B^A)
|
|
cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)->swapOperands();
|
|
I.swapOperands(); // Simplify below
|
|
std::swap(Op0, Op1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
|
|
if (B == Op0) { // B&(A^B) -> B&(B^A)
|
|
cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)->swapOperands();
|
|
std::swap(A, B);
|
|
}
|
|
if (A == Op0) // A&(A^B) -> A & ~B
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(B, "tmp"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (A&((~A)|B)) -> A&B
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)), m_Value(A))) ||
|
|
match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op1)))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op1);
|
|
if (match(Op1, m_Or(m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)), m_Value(A))) ||
|
|
match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Not(m_Specific(Op0)))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Op0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op1)) {
|
|
// (icmp1 A, B) & (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
|
|
if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// fold (and (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (and A, B))
|
|
if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind ?
|
|
const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
|
|
if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
|
|
SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
|
|
// Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
|
|
ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getType()) &&
|
|
ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getType())) {
|
|
Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0C->getOperand(0),
|
|
Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X >> Z) & (Y >> Z) -> (X&Y) >> Z for all shifts.
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
|
|
if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
|
|
SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
|
|
(SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
|
|
Value *NewOp =
|
|
Builder->CreateAnd(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
|
|
SI0->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
|
|
SI1->getOperand(1));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If and'ing two fcmp, try combine them into one.
|
|
if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = FoldAndOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// CollectBSwapParts - Analyze the specified subexpression and see if it is
|
|
/// capable of providing pieces of a bswap. The subexpression provides pieces
|
|
/// of a bswap if it is proven that each of the non-zero bytes in the output of
|
|
/// the expression came from the corresponding "byte swapped" byte in some other
|
|
/// value. For example, if the current subexpression is "(shl i32 %X, 24)" then
|
|
/// we know that the expression deposits the low byte of %X into the high byte
|
|
/// of the bswap result and that all other bytes are zero. This expression is
|
|
/// accepted, the high byte of ByteValues is set to X to indicate a correct
|
|
/// match.
|
|
///
|
|
/// This function returns true if the match was unsuccessful and false if so.
|
|
/// On entry to the function the "OverallLeftShift" is a signed integer value
|
|
/// indicating the number of bytes that the subexpression is later shifted. For
|
|
/// example, if the expression is later right shifted by 16 bits, the
|
|
/// OverallLeftShift value would be -2 on entry. This is used to specify which
|
|
/// byte of ByteValues is actually being set.
|
|
///
|
|
/// Similarly, ByteMask is a bitmask where a bit is clear if its corresponding
|
|
/// byte is masked to zero by a user. For example, in (X & 255), X will be
|
|
/// processed with a bytemask of 1. Because bytemask is 32-bits, this limits
|
|
/// this function to working on up to 32-byte (256 bit) values. ByteMask is
|
|
/// always in the local (OverallLeftShift) coordinate space.
|
|
///
|
|
static bool CollectBSwapParts(Value *V, int OverallLeftShift, uint32_t ByteMask,
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 8> &ByteValues) {
|
|
if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V)) {
|
|
// If this is an or instruction, it may be an inner node of the bswap.
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
|
|
return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
|
|
ByteValues) ||
|
|
CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(1), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
|
|
ByteValues);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this is a logical shift by a constant multiple of 8, recurse with
|
|
// OverallLeftShift and ByteMask adjusted.
|
|
if (I->isLogicalShift() && isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
unsigned ShAmt =
|
|
cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getLimitedValue(~0U);
|
|
// Ensure the shift amount is defined and of a byte value.
|
|
if ((ShAmt & 7) || (ShAmt > 8*ByteValues.size()))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
unsigned ByteShift = ShAmt >> 3;
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
|
|
// X << 2 -> collect(X, +2)
|
|
OverallLeftShift += ByteShift;
|
|
ByteMask >>= ByteShift;
|
|
} else {
|
|
// X >>u 2 -> collect(X, -2)
|
|
OverallLeftShift -= ByteShift;
|
|
ByteMask <<= ByteShift;
|
|
ByteMask &= (~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (OverallLeftShift >= (int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
|
|
if (OverallLeftShift <= -(int)ByteValues.size()) return true;
|
|
|
|
return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
|
|
ByteValues);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this is a logical 'and' with a mask that clears bytes, clear the
|
|
// corresponding bytes in ByteMask.
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// Scan every byte of the and mask, seeing if the byte is either 0 or 255.
|
|
unsigned NumBytes = ByteValues.size();
|
|
APInt Byte(I->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits(), 255);
|
|
const APInt &AndMask = cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))->getValue();
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumBytes; ++i, Byte <<= 8) {
|
|
// If this byte is masked out by a later operation, we don't care what
|
|
// the and mask is.
|
|
if ((ByteMask & (1 << i)) == 0)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
// If the AndMask is all zeros for this byte, clear the bit.
|
|
APInt MaskB = AndMask & Byte;
|
|
if (MaskB == 0) {
|
|
ByteMask &= ~(1U << i);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the AndMask is not all ones for this byte, it's not a bytezap.
|
|
if (MaskB != Byte)
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, this byte is kept.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return CollectBSwapParts(I->getOperand(0), OverallLeftShift, ByteMask,
|
|
ByteValues);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we got to something that isn't a shift, 'or' or 'and'. This must be
|
|
// the input value to the bswap. Some observations: 1) if more than one byte
|
|
// is demanded from this input, then it could not be successfully assembled
|
|
// into a byteswap. At least one of the two bytes would not be aligned with
|
|
// their ultimate destination.
|
|
if (!isPowerOf2_32(ByteMask)) return true;
|
|
unsigned InputByteNo = CountTrailingZeros_32(ByteMask);
|
|
|
|
// 2) The input and ultimate destinations must line up: if byte 3 of an i32
|
|
// is demanded, it needs to go into byte 0 of the result. This means that the
|
|
// byte needs to be shifted until it lands in the right byte bucket. The
|
|
// shift amount depends on the position: if the byte is coming from the high
|
|
// part of the value (e.g. byte 3) then it must be shifted right. If from the
|
|
// low part, it must be shifted left.
|
|
unsigned DestByteNo = InputByteNo + OverallLeftShift;
|
|
if (InputByteNo < ByteValues.size()/2) {
|
|
if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
|
|
return true;
|
|
} else {
|
|
if (ByteValues.size()-1-DestByteNo != InputByteNo)
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the destination byte value is already defined, the values are or'd
|
|
// together, which isn't a bswap (unless it's an or of the same bits).
|
|
if (ByteValues[DestByteNo] && ByteValues[DestByteNo] != V)
|
|
return true;
|
|
ByteValues[DestByteNo] = V;
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// MatchBSwap - Given an OR instruction, check to see if this is a bswap idiom.
|
|
/// If so, insert the new bswap intrinsic and return it.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::MatchBSwap(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
const IntegerType *ITy = dyn_cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
|
|
if (!ITy || ITy->getBitWidth() % 16 ||
|
|
// ByteMask only allows up to 32-byte values.
|
|
ITy->getBitWidth() > 32*8)
|
|
return 0; // Can only bswap pairs of bytes. Can't do vectors.
|
|
|
|
/// ByteValues - For each byte of the result, we keep track of which value
|
|
/// defines each byte.
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 8> ByteValues;
|
|
ByteValues.resize(ITy->getBitWidth()/8);
|
|
|
|
// Try to find all the pieces corresponding to the bswap.
|
|
uint32_t ByteMask = ~0U >> (32-ByteValues.size());
|
|
if (CollectBSwapParts(&I, 0, ByteMask, ByteValues))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if all of the bytes come from the same value.
|
|
Value *V = ByteValues[0];
|
|
if (V == 0) return 0; // Didn't find a byte? Must be zero.
|
|
|
|
// Check to make sure that all of the bytes come from the same value.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = ByteValues.size(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
if (ByteValues[i] != V)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
const Type *Tys[] = { ITy };
|
|
Module *M = I.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
|
|
Function *F = Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, Intrinsic::bswap, Tys, 1);
|
|
return CallInst::Create(F, V);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// MatchSelectFromAndOr - We have an expression of the form (A&C)|(B&D). Check
|
|
/// If A is (cond?-1:0) and either B or D is ~(cond?-1,0) or (cond?0,-1), then
|
|
/// we can simplify this expression to "cond ? C : D or B".
|
|
static Instruction *MatchSelectFromAndOr(Value *A, Value *B,
|
|
Value *C, Value *D) {
|
|
// If A is not a select of -1/0, this cannot match.
|
|
Value *Cond = 0;
|
|
if (!match(A, m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Value(Cond))))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// ((cond?-1:0)&C) | (B&(cond?0:-1)) -> cond ? C : B.
|
|
if (match(D, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
|
|
if (match(D, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, B);
|
|
// ((cond?-1:0)&C) | ((cond?0:-1)&D) -> cond ? C : D.
|
|
if (match(B, m_SelectCst<0, -1>(m_Specific(Cond))))
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
|
|
if (match(B, m_Not(m_SelectCst<-1, 0>(m_Specific(Cond)))))
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(Cond, C, D);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldOrOfICmps - Fold (icmp)|(icmp) if possible.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfICmps(Instruction &I,
|
|
ICmpInst *LHS, ICmpInst *RHS) {
|
|
Value *Val, *Val2;
|
|
ConstantInt *LHSCst, *RHSCst;
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate LHSCC, RHSCC;
|
|
|
|
// This only handles icmp of constants: (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 B, C2).
|
|
if (!match(LHS, m_ICmp(LHSCC, m_Value(Val), m_ConstantInt(LHSCst))) ||
|
|
!match(RHS, m_ICmp(RHSCC, m_Value(Val2), m_ConstantInt(RHSCst))))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
|
|
// (icmp ne A, 0) | (icmp ne B, 0) --> (icmp ne (A|B), 0)
|
|
if (LHSCst == RHSCst && LHSCC == RHSCC &&
|
|
LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE && LHSCst->isZero()) {
|
|
Value *NewOr = Builder->CreateOr(Val, Val2);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(LHSCC, NewOr, LHSCst);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// From here on, we only handle:
|
|
// (icmp1 A, C1) | (icmp2 A, C2) --> something simpler.
|
|
if (Val != Val2) return 0;
|
|
|
|
// ICMP_[US][GL]E X, CST is folded to ICMP_[US][GL]T elsewhere.
|
|
if (LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
|
|
RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
|
|
LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || LHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE ||
|
|
RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE || RHSCC == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// We can't fold (ugt x, C) | (sgt x, C2).
|
|
if (!PredicatesFoldable(LHSCC, RHSCC))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Ensure that the larger constant is on the RHS.
|
|
bool ShouldSwap;
|
|
if (CmpInst::isSigned(LHSCC) ||
|
|
(ICmpInst::isEquality(LHSCC) &&
|
|
CmpInst::isSigned(RHSCC)))
|
|
ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().sgt(RHSCst->getValue());
|
|
else
|
|
ShouldSwap = LHSCst->getValue().ugt(RHSCst->getValue());
|
|
|
|
if (ShouldSwap) {
|
|
std::swap(LHS, RHS);
|
|
std::swap(LHSCst, RHSCst);
|
|
std::swap(LHSCC, RHSCC);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// At this point, we know we have have two icmp instructions
|
|
// comparing a value against two constants and or'ing the result
|
|
// together. Because of the above check, we know that we only have
|
|
// ICMP_EQ, ICMP_NE, ICMP_LT, and ICMP_GT here. We also know (from the
|
|
// FoldICmpLogical check above), that the two constants are not
|
|
// equal.
|
|
assert(LHSCst != RHSCst && "Compares not folded above?");
|
|
|
|
switch (LHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ:
|
|
if (LHSCst == SubOne(RHSCst)) {
|
|
// (X == 13 | X == 14) -> X-13 <u 2
|
|
Constant *AddCST = ConstantExpr::getNeg(LHSCst);
|
|
Value *Add = Builder->CreateAdd(Val, AddCST, Val->getName()+".off");
|
|
AddCST = ConstantExpr::getSub(AddOne(RHSCst), LHSCst);
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT, Add, AddCST);
|
|
}
|
|
break; // (X == 13 | X == 15) -> no change
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X == 13 | X u> 14) -> no change
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X == 13 | X s> 14) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X == 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X == 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X == 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X != 13 | X == 15) -> X != 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X != 13 | X u> 15) -> X != 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X != 13 | X s> 15) -> X != 13
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X != 13 | X != 15) -> true
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X != 13 | X u< 15) -> true
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X != 13 | X s< 15) -> true
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(I.getContext()));
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u< 13 | X u> 15) -> (X-13) u> 2
|
|
// If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
|
|
// this can cause overflow.
|
|
if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(false))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
|
|
false, false, I);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u< 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u< 13 | X u< 15) -> X u< 15
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u< 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s< 13 | X == 14) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s< 13 | X s> 15) -> (X-13) s> 2
|
|
// If RHSCst is [us]MAXINT, it is always false. Not handling
|
|
// this can cause overflow.
|
|
if (RHSCst->isMaxValue(true))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
return InsertRangeTest(Val, LHSCst, AddOne(RHSCst),
|
|
true, false, I);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s< 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s< 13 | X != 15) -> X != 15
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s< 13 | X s< 15) -> X s< 15
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s< 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X u> 13 | X == 15) -> X u> 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X u> 13 | X u> 15) -> X u> 13
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X u> 13 | X s> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X u> 13 | X != 15) -> true
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X u> 13 | X u< 15) -> true
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(I.getContext()));
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X u> 13 | X s< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT:
|
|
switch (RHSCC) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("Unknown integer condition code!");
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ: // (X s> 13 | X == 15) -> X > 13
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: // (X s> 13 | X s> 15) -> X > 13
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT: // (X s> 13 | X u> 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_NE: // (X s> 13 | X != 15) -> true
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: // (X s> 13 | X s< 15) -> true
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(I.getContext()));
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT: // (X s> 13 | X u< 15) -> no change
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrOfFCmps(Instruction &I, FCmpInst *LHS,
|
|
FCmpInst *RHS) {
|
|
if (LHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
|
|
RHS->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO &&
|
|
LHS->getOperand(0)->getType() == RHS->getOperand(0)->getType()) {
|
|
if (ConstantFP *LHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(LHS->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (ConstantFP *RHSC = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(RHS->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// If either of the constants are nans, then the whole thing returns
|
|
// true.
|
|
if (LHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN() || RHSC->getValueAPF().isNaN())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(I.getContext()));
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, no need to compare the two constants, compare the
|
|
// rest.
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
|
|
LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Handle vector zeros. This occurs because the canonical form of
|
|
// "fcmp uno x,x" is "fcmp uno x, 0".
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(LHS->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(RHS->getOperand(1)))
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCmpInst::FCMP_UNO,
|
|
LHS->getOperand(0), RHS->getOperand(0));
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *Op0LHS = LHS->getOperand(0), *Op0RHS = LHS->getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *Op1LHS = RHS->getOperand(0), *Op1RHS = RHS->getOperand(1);
|
|
FCmpInst::Predicate Op0CC = LHS->getPredicate(), Op1CC = RHS->getPredicate();
|
|
|
|
if (Op0LHS == Op1RHS && Op0RHS == Op1LHS) {
|
|
// Swap RHS operands to match LHS.
|
|
Op1CC = FCmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Op1CC);
|
|
std::swap(Op1LHS, Op1RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
if (Op0LHS == Op1LHS && Op0RHS == Op1RHS) {
|
|
// Simplify (fcmp cc0 x, y) | (fcmp cc1 x, y).
|
|
if (Op0CC == Op1CC)
|
|
return new FCmpInst((FCmpInst::Predicate)Op0CC,
|
|
Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
|
|
if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE || Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_TRUE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, ConstantInt::getTrue(I.getContext()));
|
|
if (Op0CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RHS);
|
|
if (Op1CC == FCmpInst::FCMP_FALSE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, LHS);
|
|
bool Op0Ordered;
|
|
bool Op1Ordered;
|
|
unsigned Op0Pred = getFCmpCode(Op0CC, Op0Ordered);
|
|
unsigned Op1Pred = getFCmpCode(Op1CC, Op1Ordered);
|
|
if (Op0Ordered == Op1Ordered) {
|
|
// If both are ordered or unordered, return a new fcmp with
|
|
// or'ed predicates.
|
|
Value *RV = getFCmpValue(Op0Ordered, Op0Pred|Op1Pred, Op0LHS, Op0RHS);
|
|
if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(RV))
|
|
return I;
|
|
// Otherwise, it's a constant boolean value...
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, RV);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldOrWithConstants - This helper function folds:
|
|
///
|
|
/// ((A | B) & C1) | (B & C2)
|
|
///
|
|
/// into:
|
|
///
|
|
/// (A & C1) | B
|
|
///
|
|
/// when the XOR of the two constants is "all ones" (-1).
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldOrWithConstants(BinaryOperator &I, Value *Op,
|
|
Value *A, Value *B, Value *C) {
|
|
ConstantInt *CI1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
|
|
if (!CI1) return 0;
|
|
|
|
Value *V1 = 0;
|
|
ConstantInt *CI2 = 0;
|
|
if (!match(Op, m_And(m_Value(V1), m_ConstantInt(CI2)))) return 0;
|
|
|
|
APInt Xor = CI1->getValue() ^ CI2->getValue();
|
|
if (!Xor.isAllOnesValue()) return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (V1 == A || V1 == B) {
|
|
Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateAnd((V1 == A) ? B : A, CI1);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NewOp, V1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitOr(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (Value *V = SimplifyOrInst(Op0, Op1, TD))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, V);
|
|
|
|
|
|
// See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
|
|
// purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
ConstantInt *C1 = 0; Value *X = 0;
|
|
// (X & C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) & (C1|C2)
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
|
|
isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
|
|
Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
|
|
Or->takeName(Op0);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Or,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),
|
|
RHS->getValue() | C1->getValue()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X ^ C1) | C2 --> (X | C2) ^ (C1&~C2)
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(X), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
|
|
isOnlyUse(Op0)) {
|
|
Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(X, RHS);
|
|
Or->takeName(Op0);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(Or,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),
|
|
C1->getValue() & ~RHS->getValue()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *A = 0, *B = 0;
|
|
ConstantInt *C1 = 0, *C2 = 0;
|
|
|
|
// (A | B) | C and A | (B | C) -> bswap if possible.
|
|
// (A >> B) | (C << D) and (A << B) | (B >> C) -> bswap if possible.
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
|
|
match(Op1, m_Or(m_Value(), m_Value())) ||
|
|
(match(Op0, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())) &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_Shift(m_Value(), m_Value())))) {
|
|
if (Instruction *BSwap = MatchBSwap(I))
|
|
return BSwap;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X^C)|Y -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
|
|
if (Op0->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op0, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
|
|
MaskedValueIsZero(Op1, C1->getValue())) {
|
|
Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op1);
|
|
NOr->takeName(Op0);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Y|(X^C) -> (X|Y)^C iff Y&C == 0
|
|
if (Op1->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_ConstantInt(C1))) &&
|
|
MaskedValueIsZero(Op0, C1->getValue())) {
|
|
Value *NOr = Builder->CreateOr(A, Op0);
|
|
NOr->takeName(Op0);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(NOr, C1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (A & C)|(B & D)
|
|
Value *C = 0, *D = 0;
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(C))) &&
|
|
match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(B), m_Value(D)))) {
|
|
Value *V1 = 0, *V2 = 0, *V3 = 0;
|
|
C1 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C);
|
|
C2 = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(D);
|
|
if (C1 && C2) { // (A & C1)|(B & C2)
|
|
// If we have: ((V + N) & C1) | (V & C2)
|
|
// .. and C2 = ~C1 and C2 is 0+1+ and (N & C2) == 0
|
|
// replace with V+N.
|
|
if (C1->getValue() == ~C2->getValue()) {
|
|
if ((C2->getValue() & (C2->getValue()+1)) == 0 && // C2 == 0+1+
|
|
match(A, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
|
|
// Add commutes, try both ways.
|
|
if (V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C2->getValue()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
|
|
if (V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C2->getValue()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A);
|
|
}
|
|
// Or commutes, try both ways.
|
|
if ((C1->getValue() & (C1->getValue()+1)) == 0 &&
|
|
match(B, m_Add(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)))) {
|
|
// Add commutes, try both ways.
|
|
if (V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, C1->getValue()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
|
|
if (V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, C1->getValue()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ((V | N) & C1) | (V & C2) --> (V|N) & (C1|C2)
|
|
// iff (C1&C2) == 0 and (N&~C1) == 0
|
|
if ((C1->getValue() & C2->getValue()) == 0) {
|
|
if (match(A, m_Or(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2))) &&
|
|
((V1 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, ~C1->getValue())) || // (V|N)
|
|
(V2 == B && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, ~C1->getValue())))) // (N|V)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(A->getContext(),
|
|
C1->getValue()|C2->getValue()));
|
|
// Or commutes, try both ways.
|
|
if (match(B, m_Or(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2))) &&
|
|
((V1 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V2, ~C2->getValue())) || // (V|N)
|
|
(V2 == A && MaskedValueIsZero(V1, ~C2->getValue())))) // (N|V)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(B,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(B->getContext(),
|
|
C1->getValue()|C2->getValue()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if we have any common things being and'ed. If so, find the
|
|
// terms for V1 & (V2|V3).
|
|
if (isOnlyUse(Op0) || isOnlyUse(Op1)) {
|
|
V1 = 0;
|
|
if (A == B) // (A & C)|(A & D) == A & (C|D)
|
|
V1 = A, V2 = C, V3 = D;
|
|
else if (A == D) // (A & C)|(B & A) == A & (B|C)
|
|
V1 = A, V2 = B, V3 = C;
|
|
else if (C == B) // (A & C)|(C & D) == C & (A|D)
|
|
V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = D;
|
|
else if (C == D) // (A & C)|(B & C) == C & (A|B)
|
|
V1 = C, V2 = A, V3 = B;
|
|
|
|
if (V1) {
|
|
Value *Or = Builder->CreateOr(V2, V3, "tmp");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(V1, Or);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (A & (C0?-1:0)) | (B & ~(C0?-1:0)) -> C0 ? A : B, and commuted variants
|
|
if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(A, B, C, D))
|
|
return Match;
|
|
if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(B, A, D, C))
|
|
return Match;
|
|
if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(C, B, A, D))
|
|
return Match;
|
|
if (Instruction *Match = MatchSelectFromAndOr(D, A, B, C))
|
|
return Match;
|
|
|
|
// ((A&~B)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
|
|
if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
|
|
match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, D);
|
|
// ((~B&A)|(~A&B)) -> A^B
|
|
if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(D))) &&
|
|
match(B, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, D);
|
|
// ((A&~B)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
|
|
if ((match(C, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
|
|
match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(A)))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
|
|
// ((~B&A)|(B&~A)) -> A^B
|
|
if ((match(A, m_Not(m_Specific(B))) &&
|
|
match(D, m_Not(m_Specific(C)))))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(C, B);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X >> Z) | (Y >> Z) -> (X|Y) >> Z for all shifts.
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *SI1 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *SI0 = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
|
|
if (SI0->isShift() && SI0->getOpcode() == SI1->getOpcode() &&
|
|
SI0->getOperand(1) == SI1->getOperand(1) &&
|
|
(SI0->hasOneUse() || SI1->hasOneUse())) {
|
|
Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(SI0->getOperand(0), SI1->getOperand(0),
|
|
SI0->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(SI1->getOpcode(), NewOp,
|
|
SI1->getOperand(1));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ((A|B)&1)|(B&-2) -> (A&1) | B
|
|
if (match(Op0, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
|
|
match(Op0, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
|
|
Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op1, A, B, C);
|
|
if (Ret) return Ret;
|
|
}
|
|
// (B&-2)|((A|B)&1) -> (A&1) | B
|
|
if (match(Op1, m_And(m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)), m_Value(C))) ||
|
|
match(Op1, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))))) {
|
|
Instruction *Ret = FoldOrWithConstants(I, Op0, A, B, C);
|
|
if (Ret) return Ret;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (~A | ~B) == (~(A & B)) - De Morgan's Law
|
|
if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0))
|
|
if (Value *Op1NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op1))
|
|
if (Op0->hasOneUse() && Op1->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, Op1NotVal,
|
|
I.getName()+".demorgan");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateNot(And);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (icmp1 A, B) | (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
|
|
if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
if (ICmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfICmps(I, LHS, RHS))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// fold (or (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (or A, B))
|
|
if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) {// same cast kind ?
|
|
if (!isa<ICmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0)) ||
|
|
!isa<ICmpInst>(Op1C->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
|
|
if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() &&
|
|
SrcTy->isIntOrIntVector() &&
|
|
// Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be
|
|
// generated.
|
|
ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getType()) &&
|
|
ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getType())) {
|
|
Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateOr(Op0C->getOperand(0),
|
|
Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// (fcmp uno x, c) | (fcmp uno y, c) -> (fcmp uno x, y)
|
|
if (FCmpInst *LHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (FCmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = FoldOrOfFCmps(I, LHS, RHS))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
namespace {
|
|
|
|
// XorSelf - Implements: X ^ X --> 0
|
|
struct XorSelf {
|
|
Value *RHS;
|
|
XorSelf(Value *rhs) : RHS(rhs) {}
|
|
bool shouldApply(Value *LHS) const { return LHS == RHS; }
|
|
Instruction *apply(BinaryOperator &Xor) const {
|
|
return &Xor;
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitXor(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool Changed = SimplifyCommutative(I);
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0))
|
|
// Handle undef ^ undef -> 0 special case. This is a common
|
|
// idiom (misuse).
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op1); // X ^ undef -> undef
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// xor X, X = 0, even if X is nested in a sequence of Xor's.
|
|
if (Instruction *Result = AssociativeOpt(I, XorSelf(Op1))) {
|
|
assert(Result == &I && "AssociativeOpt didn't work?"); Result=Result;
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
|
|
// purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
if (isa<VectorType>(I.getType()))
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(Op1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0); // X ^ <0,0> -> X
|
|
|
|
// Is this a ~ operation?
|
|
if (Value *NotOp = dyn_castNotVal(&I)) {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(NotOp)) {
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And ||
|
|
Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
|
|
// ~(~X & Y) --> (X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
|
|
// ~(~X | Y) === (X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
|
|
if (dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(1)))
|
|
Op0I->swapOperands();
|
|
if (Value *Op0NotVal = dyn_castNotVal(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
Value *NotY =
|
|
Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1),
|
|
Op0I->getOperand(1)->getName()+".not");
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(Op0NotVal, NotY);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Op0NotVal, NotY);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ~(X & Y) --> (~X | ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
|
|
// ~(X | Y) === (~X & ~Y) - De Morgan's Law
|
|
if (isFreeToInvert(Op0I->getOperand(0)) &&
|
|
isFreeToInvert(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
Value *NotX =
|
|
Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(0), "notlhs");
|
|
Value *NotY =
|
|
Builder->CreateNot(Op0I->getOperand(1), "notrhs");
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::And)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotX, NotY);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotX, NotY);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (RHS->isOne() && Op0->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// xor (cmp A, B), true = not (cmp A, B) = !cmp A, B
|
|
if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(Op0))
|
|
return new ICmpInst(ICI->getInversePredicate(),
|
|
ICI->getOperand(0), ICI->getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(Op0))
|
|
return new FCmpInst(FCI->getInversePredicate(),
|
|
FCI->getOperand(0), FCI->getOperand(1));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// fold (xor(zext(cmp)), 1) and (xor(sext(cmp)), -1) to ext(!cmp).
|
|
if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(Op0C->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (CI->hasOneUse() && Op0C->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Instruction::CastOps Opcode = Op0C->getOpcode();
|
|
if ((Opcode == Instruction::ZExt || Opcode == Instruction::SExt) &&
|
|
(RHS == ConstantExpr::getCast(Opcode,
|
|
ConstantInt::getTrue(I.getContext()),
|
|
Op0C->getDestTy()))) {
|
|
CI->setPredicate(CI->getInversePredicate());
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Opcode, CI, Op0C->getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
|
|
// ~(c-X) == X-c-1 == X+(-c-1)
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub && RHS->isAllOnesValue())
|
|
if (Constant *Op0I0C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Op0I->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
Constant *NegOp0I0C = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0I0C);
|
|
Constant *ConstantRHS = ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0I0C,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(1), ConstantRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *Op0CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0I->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) {
|
|
// ~(X-c) --> (-c-1)-X
|
|
if (RHS->isAllOnesValue()) {
|
|
Constant *NegOp0CI = ConstantExpr::getNeg(Op0CI);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(
|
|
ConstantExpr::getSub(NegOp0CI,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), 1)),
|
|
Op0I->getOperand(0));
|
|
} else if (RHS->getValue().isSignBit()) {
|
|
// (X + C) ^ signbit -> (X + C + signbit)
|
|
Constant *C = ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),
|
|
RHS->getValue() + Op0CI->getValue());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(Op0I->getOperand(0), C);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (Op0I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Or) {
|
|
// (X|C1)^C2 -> X^(C1|C2) iff X&~C1 == 0
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op0CI->getValue())) {
|
|
Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getOr(Op0CI, RHS);
|
|
// Anything in both C1 and C2 is known to be zero, remove it from
|
|
// NewRHS.
|
|
Constant *CommonBits = ConstantExpr::getAnd(Op0CI, RHS);
|
|
NewRHS = ConstantExpr::getAnd(NewRHS,
|
|
ConstantExpr::getNot(CommonBits));
|
|
Worklist.Add(Op0I);
|
|
I.setOperand(0, Op0I->getOperand(0));
|
|
I.setOperand(1, NewRHS);
|
|
return &I;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op0)) // ~A ^ A == -1
|
|
if (X == Op1)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (Value *X = dyn_castNotVal(Op1)) // A ^ ~A == -1
|
|
if (X == Op0)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getAllOnesValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
|
|
BinaryOperator *Op1I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op1);
|
|
if (Op1I) {
|
|
Value *A, *B;
|
|
if (match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B)))) {
|
|
if (A == Op0) { // B^(B|A) == (A|B)^B
|
|
Op1I->swapOperands();
|
|
I.swapOperands();
|
|
std::swap(Op0, Op1);
|
|
} else if (B == Op0) { // B^(A|B) == (A|B)^B
|
|
I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
|
|
std::swap(Op0, Op1);
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op0), m_Value(B)))) {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // A^(A^B) == B
|
|
} else if (match(Op1I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op0)))) {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // A^(B^A) == B
|
|
} else if (match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
Op1I->hasOneUse()){
|
|
if (A == Op0) { // A^(A&B) -> A^(B&A)
|
|
Op1I->swapOperands();
|
|
std::swap(A, B);
|
|
}
|
|
if (B == Op0) { // A^(B&A) -> (B&A)^A
|
|
I.swapOperands(); // Simplified below.
|
|
std::swap(Op0, Op1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
BinaryOperator *Op0I = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
|
|
if (Op0I) {
|
|
Value *A, *B;
|
|
if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
Op0I->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
if (A == Op1) // (B|A)^B == (A|B)^B
|
|
std::swap(A, B);
|
|
if (B == Op1) // (A|B)^B == A & ~B
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(A, Builder->CreateNot(Op1, "tmp"));
|
|
} else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Specific(Op1), m_Value(B)))) {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, B); // (A^B)^A == B
|
|
} else if (match(Op0I, m_Xor(m_Value(A), m_Specific(Op1)))) {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, A); // (B^A)^A == B
|
|
} else if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
Op0I->hasOneUse()){
|
|
if (A == Op1) // (A&B)^A -> (B&A)^A
|
|
std::swap(A, B);
|
|
if (B == Op1 && // (B&A)^A == ~B & A
|
|
!isa<ConstantInt>(Op1)) { // Canonical form is (B&C)^C
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Builder->CreateNot(A, "tmp"), Op1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X >> Z) ^ (Y >> Z) -> (X^Y) >> Z for all shifts.
|
|
if (Op0I && Op1I && Op0I->isShift() &&
|
|
Op0I->getOpcode() == Op1I->getOpcode() &&
|
|
Op0I->getOperand(1) == Op1I->getOperand(1) &&
|
|
(Op1I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse())) {
|
|
Value *NewOp =
|
|
Builder->CreateXor(Op0I->getOperand(0), Op1I->getOperand(0),
|
|
Op0I->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Op1I->getOpcode(), NewOp,
|
|
Op1I->getOperand(1));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Op0I && Op1I) {
|
|
Value *A, *B, *C, *D;
|
|
// (A & B)^(A | B) -> A ^ B
|
|
if (match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
match(Op1I, m_Or(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
|
|
if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
|
|
}
|
|
// (A | B)^(A & B) -> A ^ B
|
|
if (match(Op0I, m_Or(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
|
|
if ((A == C && B == D) || (A == D && B == C))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateXor(A, B);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (A & B)^(C & D)
|
|
if ((Op0I->hasOneUse() || Op1I->hasOneUse()) &&
|
|
match(Op0I, m_And(m_Value(A), m_Value(B))) &&
|
|
match(Op1I, m_And(m_Value(C), m_Value(D)))) {
|
|
// (X & Y)^(X & Y) -> (Y^Z) & X
|
|
Value *X = 0, *Y = 0, *Z = 0;
|
|
if (A == C)
|
|
X = A, Y = B, Z = D;
|
|
else if (A == D)
|
|
X = A, Y = B, Z = C;
|
|
else if (B == C)
|
|
X = B, Y = A, Z = D;
|
|
else if (B == D)
|
|
X = B, Y = A, Z = C;
|
|
|
|
if (X) {
|
|
Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Y, Z, Op0->getName());
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NewOp, X);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (icmp1 A, B) ^ (icmp2 A, B) --> (icmp3 A, B)
|
|
if (ICmpInst *RHS = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(I.getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = AssociativeOpt(I, FoldICmpLogical(*this, RHS)))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
// fold (xor (cast A), (cast B)) -> (cast (xor A, B))
|
|
if (CastInst *Op0C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (CastInst *Op1C = dyn_cast<CastInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (Op0C->getOpcode() == Op1C->getOpcode()) { // same cast kind?
|
|
const Type *SrcTy = Op0C->getOperand(0)->getType();
|
|
if (SrcTy == Op1C->getOperand(0)->getType() && SrcTy->isInteger() &&
|
|
// Only do this if the casts both really cause code to be generated.
|
|
ValueRequiresCast(Op0C->getOpcode(), Op0C->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getType()) &&
|
|
ValueRequiresCast(Op1C->getOpcode(), Op1C->getOperand(0),
|
|
I.getType())) {
|
|
Value *NewOp = Builder->CreateXor(Op0C->getOperand(0),
|
|
Op1C->getOperand(0), I.getName());
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Op0C->getOpcode(), NewOp, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? &I : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShl(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
return commonShiftTransforms(I);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
return commonShiftTransforms(I);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAShr(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
if (Instruction *R = commonShiftTransforms(I))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
// ashr int -1, X = -1 (for any arithmetic shift rights of ~0)
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0))
|
|
if (CSI->isAllOnesValue())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, CSI);
|
|
|
|
// See if we can turn a signed shr into an unsigned shr.
|
|
if (MaskedValueIsZero(Op0,
|
|
APInt::getSignBit(I.getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(Op0, I.getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
// Arithmetic shifting an all-sign-bit value is a no-op.
|
|
unsigned NumSignBits = ComputeNumSignBits(Op0);
|
|
if (NumSignBits == Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::commonShiftTransforms(BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
assert(I.getOperand(1)->getType() == I.getOperand(0)->getType());
|
|
Value *Op0 = I.getOperand(0), *Op1 = I.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// shl X, 0 == X and shr X, 0 == X
|
|
// shl 0, X == 0 and shr 0, X == 0
|
|
if (Op1 == Constant::getNullValue(Op1->getType()) ||
|
|
Op0 == Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op0)) {
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // undef >>s X -> undef
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
else // undef << X -> 0, undef >>u X -> 0
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op1)) {
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) // X >>s undef -> X
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Op0);
|
|
else // X << undef, X >>u undef -> 0
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we can fold away this shift.
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedInstructionBits(I))
|
|
return &I;
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(Op0))
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op1))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CUI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op1))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = FoldShiftByConstant(Op0, CUI, I))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldShiftByConstant(Value *Op0, ConstantInt *Op1,
|
|
BinaryOperator &I) {
|
|
bool isLeftShift = I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl;
|
|
|
|
// See if we can simplify any instructions used by the instruction whose sole
|
|
// purpose is to compute bits we don't care about.
|
|
uint32_t TypeBits = Op0->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
|
|
|
|
// shl i32 X, 32 = 0 and srl i8 Y, 9 = 0, ... just don't eliminate
|
|
// a signed shift.
|
|
//
|
|
if (Op1->uge(TypeBits)) {
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(Op0->getType()));
|
|
else {
|
|
I.setOperand(1, ConstantInt::get(I.getType(), TypeBits-1));
|
|
return &I;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ((X*C1) << C2) == (X * (C1 << C2))
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0))
|
|
if (BO->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul && isLeftShift)
|
|
if (Constant *BOOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(BO->getOperand(1)))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(BO->getOperand(0),
|
|
ConstantExpr::getShl(BOOp, Op1));
|
|
|
|
// Try to fold constant and into select arguments.
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldOpIntoSelect(I, SI))
|
|
return R;
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(Op0))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(I))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
|
|
// Fold shift2(trunc(shift1(x,c1)), c2) -> trunc(shift2(shift1(x,c1),c2))
|
|
if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(Op0)) {
|
|
Instruction *TrOp = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TI->getOperand(0));
|
|
// If 'shift2' is an ashr, we would have to get the sign bit into a funny
|
|
// place. Don't try to do this transformation in this case. Also, we
|
|
// require that the input operand is a shift-by-constant so that we have
|
|
// confidence that the shifts will get folded together. We could do this
|
|
// xform in more cases, but it is unlikely to be profitable.
|
|
if (TrOp && I.isLogicalShift() && TrOp->isShift() &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(TrOp->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// Okay, we'll do this xform. Make the shift of shift.
|
|
Constant *ShAmt = ConstantExpr::getZExt(Op1, TrOp->getType());
|
|
// (shift2 (shift1 & 0x00FF), c2)
|
|
Value *NSh = Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), TrOp, ShAmt,I.getName());
|
|
|
|
// For logical shifts, the truncation has the effect of making the high
|
|
// part of the register be zeros. Emulate this by inserting an AND to
|
|
// clear the top bits as needed. This 'and' will usually be zapped by
|
|
// other xforms later if dead.
|
|
unsigned SrcSize = TrOp->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
|
|
unsigned DstSize = TI->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits();
|
|
APInt MaskV(APInt::getLowBitsSet(SrcSize, DstSize));
|
|
|
|
// The mask we constructed says what the trunc would do if occurring
|
|
// between the shifts. We want to know the effect *after* the second
|
|
// shift. We know that it is a logical shift by a constant, so adjust the
|
|
// mask as appropriate.
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl)
|
|
MaskV <<= Op1->getZExtValue();
|
|
else {
|
|
assert(I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr && "Unknown logical shift");
|
|
MaskV = MaskV.lshr(Op1->getZExtValue());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// shift1 & 0x00FF
|
|
Value *And = Builder->CreateAnd(NSh,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(), MaskV),
|
|
TI->getName());
|
|
|
|
// Return the value truncated to the interesting size.
|
|
return new TruncInst(And, I.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Op0->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *Op0BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0)) {
|
|
// Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
|
|
Value *V1, *V2;
|
|
ConstantInt *CC;
|
|
switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
|
|
default: break;
|
|
case Instruction::Add:
|
|
case Instruction::And:
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
case Instruction::Xor: {
|
|
// These operators commute.
|
|
// Turn (Y + (X >> C)) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
|
|
if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(1)->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op0BO->getOperand(1), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
|
|
m_Specific(Op1)))) {
|
|
Value *YS = // (Y << C)
|
|
Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
|
|
// (X + (Y << C))
|
|
Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, V1,
|
|
Op0BO->getOperand(1)->getName());
|
|
uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),
|
|
APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Turn (Y + ((X >> C) & CC)) << C -> ((X & (CC << C)) + (Y << C))
|
|
Value *Op0BOOp1 = Op0BO->getOperand(1);
|
|
if (isLeftShift && Op0BOOp1->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op0BOOp1,
|
|
m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Specific(Op1)),
|
|
m_ConstantInt(CC))) &&
|
|
cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BOOp1)->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Value *YS = // (Y << C)
|
|
Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1,
|
|
Op0BO->getName());
|
|
// X & (CC << C)
|
|
Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
|
|
V1->getName()+".mask");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), YS, XM);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// FALL THROUGH.
|
|
case Instruction::Sub: {
|
|
// Turn ((X >> C) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (~0 << C)
|
|
if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op0BO->getOperand(0), m_Shr(m_Value(V1),
|
|
m_Specific(Op1)))) {
|
|
Value *YS = // (Y << C)
|
|
Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
|
|
// (X + (Y << C))
|
|
Value *X = Builder->CreateBinOp(Op0BO->getOpcode(), V1, YS,
|
|
Op0BO->getOperand(0)->getName());
|
|
uint32_t Op1Val = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X, ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),
|
|
APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits-Op1Val)));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Turn (((X >> C)&CC) + Y) << C -> (X + (Y << C)) & (CC << C)
|
|
if (isLeftShift && Op0BO->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
match(Op0BO->getOperand(0),
|
|
m_And(m_Shr(m_Value(V1), m_Value(V2)),
|
|
m_ConstantInt(CC))) && V2 == Op1 &&
|
|
cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0BO->getOperand(0))
|
|
->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Value *YS = // (Y << C)
|
|
Builder->CreateShl(Op0BO->getOperand(1), Op1, Op0BO->getName());
|
|
// X & (CC << C)
|
|
Value *XM = Builder->CreateAnd(V1, ConstantExpr::getShl(CC, Op1),
|
|
V1->getName()+".mask");
|
|
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), XM, YS);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// If the operand is an bitwise operator with a constant RHS, and the
|
|
// shift is the only use, we can pull it out of the shift.
|
|
if (ConstantInt *Op0C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(Op0BO->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
bool isValid = true; // Valid only for And, Or, Xor
|
|
bool highBitSet = false; // Transform if high bit of constant set?
|
|
|
|
switch (Op0BO->getOpcode()) {
|
|
default: isValid = false; break; // Do not perform transform!
|
|
case Instruction::Add:
|
|
isValid = isLeftShift;
|
|
break;
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
case Instruction::Xor:
|
|
highBitSet = false;
|
|
break;
|
|
case Instruction::And:
|
|
highBitSet = true;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this is a signed shift right, and the high bit is modified
|
|
// by the logical operation, do not perform the transformation.
|
|
// The highBitSet boolean indicates the value of the high bit of
|
|
// the constant which would cause it to be modified for this
|
|
// operation.
|
|
//
|
|
if (isValid && I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr)
|
|
isValid = Op0C->getValue()[TypeBits-1] == highBitSet;
|
|
|
|
if (isValid) {
|
|
Constant *NewRHS = ConstantExpr::get(I.getOpcode(), Op0C, Op1);
|
|
|
|
Value *NewShift =
|
|
Builder->CreateBinOp(I.getOpcode(), Op0BO->getOperand(0), Op1);
|
|
NewShift->takeName(Op0BO);
|
|
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(Op0BO->getOpcode(), NewShift,
|
|
NewRHS);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Find out if this is a shift of a shift by a constant.
|
|
BinaryOperator *ShiftOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(Op0);
|
|
if (ShiftOp && !ShiftOp->isShift())
|
|
ShiftOp = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (ShiftOp && isa<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
ConstantInt *ShiftAmt1C = cast<ConstantInt>(ShiftOp->getOperand(1));
|
|
uint32_t ShiftAmt1 = ShiftAmt1C->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
|
|
uint32_t ShiftAmt2 = Op1->getLimitedValue(TypeBits);
|
|
assert(ShiftAmt2 != 0 && "Should have been simplified earlier");
|
|
if (ShiftAmt1 == 0) return 0; // Will be simplified in the future.
|
|
Value *X = ShiftOp->getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
uint32_t AmtSum = ShiftAmt1+ShiftAmt2; // Fold into one big shift.
|
|
|
|
const IntegerType *Ty = cast<IntegerType>(I.getType());
|
|
|
|
// Check for (X << c1) << c2 and (X >> c1) >> c2
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == ShiftOp->getOpcode()) {
|
|
// If this is oversized composite shift, then unsigned shifts get 0, ashr
|
|
// saturates.
|
|
if (AmtSum >= TypeBits) {
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() != Instruction::AShr)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
AmtSum = TypeBits-1; // Saturate to 31 for i32 ashr.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(I.getOpcode(), X,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr &&
|
|
I.getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr) {
|
|
if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(I, Constant::getNullValue(I.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// ((X >>u C1) >>s C2) -> (X >>u (C1+C2)) since C1 != 0.
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr &&
|
|
I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
|
|
// ((X >>s C1) >>u C2) -> ((X >>s (C1+C2)) & mask) since C1 != 0.
|
|
if (AmtSum >= TypeBits)
|
|
AmtSum = TypeBits-1;
|
|
|
|
Value *Shift = Builder->CreateAShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, AmtSum));
|
|
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(), Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Okay, if we get here, one shift must be left, and the other shift must be
|
|
// right. See if the amounts are equal.
|
|
if (ShiftAmt1 == ShiftAmt2) {
|
|
// If we have ((X >>? C) << C), turn this into X & (-1 << C).
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
// If we have ((X << C) >>u C), turn this into X & (-1 >>u C).
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt1));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(X,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(), Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
// We can simplify ((X << C) >>s C) into a trunc + sext.
|
|
// NOTE: we could do this for any C, but that would make 'unusual' integer
|
|
// types. For now, just stick to ones well-supported by the code
|
|
// generators.
|
|
const Type *SExtType = 0;
|
|
switch (Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1) {
|
|
case 1 :
|
|
case 8 :
|
|
case 16 :
|
|
case 32 :
|
|
case 64 :
|
|
case 128:
|
|
SExtType = IntegerType::get(I.getContext(),
|
|
Ty->getBitWidth() - ShiftAmt1);
|
|
break;
|
|
default: break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (SExtType)
|
|
return new SExtInst(Builder->CreateTrunc(X, SExtType, "sext"), Ty);
|
|
// Otherwise, we can't handle it yet.
|
|
} else if (ShiftAmt1 < ShiftAmt2) {
|
|
uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt2-ShiftAmt1;
|
|
|
|
// (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X << (C2-C1) & (-1 << C2)
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
|
|
assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
|
|
ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
|
|
Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
|
|
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X >>u (C2-C1) & (-1 >> C2)
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
|
|
assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
|
|
Value *Shift = Builder->CreateLShr(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
|
|
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// We can't handle (X << C1) >>s C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
|
|
} else {
|
|
assert(ShiftAmt2 < ShiftAmt1);
|
|
uint32_t ShiftDiff = ShiftAmt1-ShiftAmt2;
|
|
|
|
// (X >>? C1) << C2 --> X >>? (C1-C2) & (-1 << C2)
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl) {
|
|
assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr ||
|
|
ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::AShr);
|
|
Value *Shift = Builder->CreateBinOp(ShiftOp->getOpcode(), X,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
|
|
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getHighBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (X << C1) >>u C2 --> X << (C1-C2) & (-1 >> C2)
|
|
if (I.getOpcode() == Instruction::LShr) {
|
|
assert(ShiftOp->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl);
|
|
Value *Shift = Builder->CreateShl(X, ConstantInt::get(Ty, ShiftDiff));
|
|
|
|
APInt Mask(APInt::getLowBitsSet(TypeBits, TypeBits - ShiftAmt2));
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(Shift,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(I.getContext(),Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// We can't handle (X << C1) >>a C2, it shifts arbitrary bits in.
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// FindElementAtOffset - Given a type and a constant offset, determine whether
|
|
/// or not there is a sequence of GEP indices into the type that will land us at
|
|
/// the specified offset. If so, fill them into NewIndices and return the
|
|
/// resultant element type, otherwise return null.
|
|
const Type *InstCombiner::FindElementAtOffset(const Type *Ty, int64_t Offset,
|
|
SmallVectorImpl<Value*> &NewIndices) {
|
|
if (!TD) return 0;
|
|
if (!Ty->isSized()) return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Start with the index over the outer type. Note that the type size
|
|
// might be zero (even if the offset isn't zero) if the indexed type
|
|
// is something like [0 x {int, int}]
|
|
const Type *IntPtrTy = TD->getIntPtrType(Ty->getContext());
|
|
int64_t FirstIdx = 0;
|
|
if (int64_t TySize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(Ty)) {
|
|
FirstIdx = Offset/TySize;
|
|
Offset -= FirstIdx*TySize;
|
|
|
|
// Handle hosts where % returns negative instead of values [0..TySize).
|
|
if (Offset < 0) {
|
|
--FirstIdx;
|
|
Offset += TySize;
|
|
assert(Offset >= 0);
|
|
}
|
|
assert((uint64_t)Offset < (uint64_t)TySize && "Out of range offset");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy, FirstIdx));
|
|
|
|
// Index into the types. If we fail, set OrigBase to null.
|
|
while (Offset) {
|
|
// Indexing into tail padding between struct/array elements.
|
|
if (uint64_t(Offset*8) >= TD->getTypeSizeInBits(Ty))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(Ty)) {
|
|
const StructLayout *SL = TD->getStructLayout(STy);
|
|
assert(Offset < (int64_t)SL->getSizeInBytes() &&
|
|
"Offset must stay within the indexed type");
|
|
|
|
unsigned Elt = SL->getElementContainingOffset(Offset);
|
|
NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(Ty->getContext()),
|
|
Elt));
|
|
|
|
Offset -= SL->getElementOffset(Elt);
|
|
Ty = STy->getElementType(Elt);
|
|
} else if (const ArrayType *AT = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(Ty)) {
|
|
uint64_t EltSize = TD->getTypeAllocSize(AT->getElementType());
|
|
assert(EltSize && "Cannot index into a zero-sized array");
|
|
NewIndices.push_back(ConstantInt::get(IntPtrTy,Offset/EltSize));
|
|
Offset %= EltSize;
|
|
Ty = AT->getElementType();
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Otherwise, we can't index into the middle of this atomic type, bail.
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Ty;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// GetSelectFoldableOperands - We want to turn code that looks like this:
|
|
/// %C = or %A, %B
|
|
/// %D = select %cond, %C, %A
|
|
/// into:
|
|
/// %C = select %cond, %B, 0
|
|
/// %D = or %A, %C
|
|
///
|
|
/// Assuming that the specified instruction is an operand to the select, return
|
|
/// a bitmask indicating which operands of this instruction are foldable if they
|
|
/// equal the other incoming value of the select.
|
|
///
|
|
static unsigned GetSelectFoldableOperands(Instruction *I) {
|
|
switch (I->getOpcode()) {
|
|
case Instruction::Add:
|
|
case Instruction::Mul:
|
|
case Instruction::And:
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
case Instruction::Xor:
|
|
return 3; // Can fold through either operand.
|
|
case Instruction::Sub: // Can only fold on the amount subtracted.
|
|
case Instruction::Shl: // Can only fold on the shift amount.
|
|
case Instruction::LShr:
|
|
case Instruction::AShr:
|
|
return 1;
|
|
default:
|
|
return 0; // Cannot fold
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// GetSelectFoldableConstant - For the same transformation as the previous
|
|
/// function, return the identity constant that goes into the select.
|
|
static Constant *GetSelectFoldableConstant(Instruction *I) {
|
|
switch (I->getOpcode()) {
|
|
default: llvm_unreachable("This cannot happen!");
|
|
case Instruction::Add:
|
|
case Instruction::Sub:
|
|
case Instruction::Or:
|
|
case Instruction::Xor:
|
|
case Instruction::Shl:
|
|
case Instruction::LShr:
|
|
case Instruction::AShr:
|
|
return Constant::getNullValue(I->getType());
|
|
case Instruction::And:
|
|
return Constant::getAllOnesValue(I->getType());
|
|
case Instruction::Mul:
|
|
return ConstantInt::get(I->getType(), 1);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldSelectOpOp - Here we have (select c, TI, FI), and we know that TI and FI
|
|
/// have the same opcode and only one use each. Try to simplify this.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectOpOp(SelectInst &SI, Instruction *TI,
|
|
Instruction *FI) {
|
|
if (TI->getNumOperands() == 1) {
|
|
// If this is a non-volatile load or a cast from the same type,
|
|
// merge.
|
|
if (TI->isCast()) {
|
|
if (TI->getOperand(0)->getType() != FI->getOperand(0)->getType())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
} else {
|
|
return 0; // unknown unary op.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Fold this by inserting a select from the input values.
|
|
SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), TI->getOperand(0),
|
|
FI->getOperand(0), SI.getName()+".v");
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Instruction::CastOps(TI->getOpcode()), NewSI,
|
|
TI->getType());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Only handle binary operators here.
|
|
if (!isa<BinaryOperator>(TI))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Figure out if the operations have any operands in common.
|
|
Value *MatchOp, *OtherOpT, *OtherOpF;
|
|
bool MatchIsOpZero;
|
|
if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
|
|
OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
|
|
OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
|
|
MatchIsOpZero = true;
|
|
} else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
|
|
MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
|
|
OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
|
|
OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
|
|
MatchIsOpZero = false;
|
|
} else if (!TI->isCommutative()) {
|
|
return 0;
|
|
} else if (TI->getOperand(0) == FI->getOperand(1)) {
|
|
MatchOp = TI->getOperand(0);
|
|
OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(1);
|
|
OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(0);
|
|
MatchIsOpZero = true;
|
|
} else if (TI->getOperand(1) == FI->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
MatchOp = TI->getOperand(1);
|
|
OtherOpT = TI->getOperand(0);
|
|
OtherOpF = FI->getOperand(1);
|
|
MatchIsOpZero = true;
|
|
} else {
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we reach here, they do have operations in common.
|
|
SelectInst *NewSI = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OtherOpT,
|
|
OtherOpF, SI.getName()+".v");
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewSI, SI);
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TI)) {
|
|
if (MatchIsOpZero)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), MatchOp, NewSI);
|
|
else
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), NewSI, MatchOp);
|
|
}
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Shouldn't get here");
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
static bool isSelect01(Constant *C1, Constant *C2) {
|
|
ConstantInt *C1I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C1);
|
|
if (!C1I)
|
|
return false;
|
|
ConstantInt *C2I = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(C2);
|
|
if (!C2I)
|
|
return false;
|
|
return (C1I->isZero() || C1I->isOne()) && (C2I->isZero() || C2I->isOne());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldSelectIntoOp - Try fold the select into one of the operands to
|
|
/// facilitate further optimization.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSelectIntoOp(SelectInst &SI, Value *TrueVal,
|
|
Value *FalseVal) {
|
|
// See the comment above GetSelectFoldableOperands for a description of the
|
|
// transformation we are doing here.
|
|
if (Instruction *TVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal)) {
|
|
if (TVI->hasOneUse() && TVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
|
|
!isa<Constant>(FalseVal)) {
|
|
if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(TVI)) {
|
|
unsigned OpToFold = 0;
|
|
if ((SFO & 1) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
OpToFold = 1;
|
|
} else if ((SFO & 2) && FalseVal == TVI->getOperand(1)) {
|
|
OpToFold = 2;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (OpToFold) {
|
|
Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(TVI);
|
|
Value *OOp = TVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
|
|
// Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
|
|
// between 0 and 1.
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
|
|
Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), OOp, C);
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
|
|
NewSel->takeName(TVI);
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(TVI))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), FalseVal, NewSel);
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *FVI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal)) {
|
|
if (FVI->hasOneUse() && FVI->getNumOperands() == 2 &&
|
|
!isa<Constant>(TrueVal)) {
|
|
if (unsigned SFO = GetSelectFoldableOperands(FVI)) {
|
|
unsigned OpToFold = 0;
|
|
if ((SFO & 1) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
OpToFold = 1;
|
|
} else if ((SFO & 2) && TrueVal == FVI->getOperand(1)) {
|
|
OpToFold = 2;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (OpToFold) {
|
|
Constant *C = GetSelectFoldableConstant(FVI);
|
|
Value *OOp = FVI->getOperand(2-OpToFold);
|
|
// Avoid creating select between 2 constants unless it's selecting
|
|
// between 0 and 1.
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(OOp) || isSelect01(C, cast<Constant>(OOp))) {
|
|
Instruction *NewSel = SelectInst::Create(SI.getCondition(), C, OOp);
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
|
|
NewSel->takeName(FVI);
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FVI))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), TrueVal, NewSel);
|
|
llvm_unreachable("Unknown instruction!!");
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// visitSelectInstWithICmp - Visit a SelectInst that has an
|
|
/// ICmpInst as its first operand.
|
|
///
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInstWithICmp(SelectInst &SI,
|
|
ICmpInst *ICI) {
|
|
bool Changed = false;
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
|
|
Value *CmpLHS = ICI->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *CmpRHS = ICI->getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
|
|
Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
|
|
|
|
// Check cases where the comparison is with a constant that
|
|
// can be adjusted to fit the min/max idiom. We may edit ICI in
|
|
// place here, so make sure the select is the only user.
|
|
if (ICI->hasOneUse())
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CmpRHS)) {
|
|
switch (Pred) {
|
|
default: break;
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_ULT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT: {
|
|
// X < MIN ? T : F --> F
|
|
if (CI->isMinValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
// X < C ? X : C-1 --> X > C-1 ? C-1 : X
|
|
Constant *AdjustedRHS = SubOne(CI);
|
|
if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
|
|
(CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
|
|
Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
|
|
CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
|
|
std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
|
|
ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
|
|
ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
|
|
SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
|
|
SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
|
|
Changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_UGT:
|
|
case ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT: {
|
|
// X > MAX ? T : F --> F
|
|
if (CI->isMaxValue(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
// X > C ? X : C+1 --> X < C+1 ? C+1 : X
|
|
Constant *AdjustedRHS = AddOne(CI);
|
|
if ((CmpLHS == TrueVal && AdjustedRHS == FalseVal) ||
|
|
(CmpLHS == FalseVal && AdjustedRHS == TrueVal)) {
|
|
Pred = ICmpInst::getSwappedPredicate(Pred);
|
|
CmpRHS = AdjustedRHS;
|
|
std::swap(FalseVal, TrueVal);
|
|
ICI->setPredicate(Pred);
|
|
ICI->setOperand(1, CmpRHS);
|
|
SI.setOperand(1, TrueVal);
|
|
SI.setOperand(2, FalseVal);
|
|
Changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// (x <s 0) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if signed
|
|
// (x >s -1) ? -1 : 0 -> ashr x, 31 -> all ones if not signed
|
|
CmpInst::Predicate Pred = CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE;
|
|
if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()) &&
|
|
match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()))
|
|
Pred = ICI->getPredicate();
|
|
else if (match(TrueVal, m_ConstantInt<0>()) &&
|
|
match(FalseVal, m_ConstantInt<-1>()))
|
|
Pred = CmpInst::getInversePredicate(ICI->getPredicate());
|
|
|
|
if (Pred != CmpInst::BAD_ICMP_PREDICATE) {
|
|
// If we are just checking for a icmp eq of a single bit and zext'ing it
|
|
// to an integer, then shift the bit to the appropriate place and then
|
|
// cast to integer to avoid the comparison.
|
|
const APInt &Op1CV = CI->getValue();
|
|
|
|
// sext (x <s 0) to i32 --> x>>s31 true if signbit set.
|
|
// sext (x >s -1) to i32 --> (x>>s31)^-1 true if signbit clear.
|
|
if ((Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLT && Op1CV == 0) ||
|
|
(Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT && Op1CV.isAllOnesValue())) {
|
|
Value *In = ICI->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *Sh = ConstantInt::get(In->getType(),
|
|
In->getType()->getScalarSizeInBits()-1);
|
|
In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateAShr(In, Sh,
|
|
In->getName()+".lobit"),
|
|
*ICI);
|
|
if (In->getType() != SI.getType())
|
|
In = CastInst::CreateIntegerCast(In, SI.getType(),
|
|
true/*SExt*/, "tmp", ICI);
|
|
|
|
if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGT)
|
|
In = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(In,
|
|
In->getName()+".not"), *ICI);
|
|
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, In);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (CmpLHS == TrueVal && CmpRHS == FalseVal) {
|
|
// Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
|
|
if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
// Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
|
|
if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
/// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
|
|
|
|
} else if (CmpLHS == FalseVal && CmpRHS == TrueVal) {
|
|
// Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
|
|
if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_EQ)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
// Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
|
|
if (Pred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
/// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect integer MIN/MAX
|
|
}
|
|
return Changed ? &SI : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock - SI is a select whose condition is a
|
|
/// PHI node (but the two may be in different blocks). See if the true/false
|
|
/// values (V) are live in all of the predecessor blocks of the PHI. For
|
|
/// example, cases like this cannot be mapped:
|
|
///
|
|
/// X = phi [ C1, BB1], [C2, BB2]
|
|
/// Y = add
|
|
/// Z = select X, Y, 0
|
|
///
|
|
/// because Y is not live in BB1/BB2.
|
|
///
|
|
static bool CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(const Value *V,
|
|
const SelectInst &SI) {
|
|
// If the value is a non-instruction value like a constant or argument, it
|
|
// can always be mapped.
|
|
const Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
|
|
if (I == 0) return true;
|
|
|
|
// If V is a PHI node defined in the same block as the condition PHI, we can
|
|
// map the arguments.
|
|
const PHINode *CondPHI = cast<PHINode>(SI.getCondition());
|
|
|
|
if (const PHINode *VP = dyn_cast<PHINode>(I))
|
|
if (VP->getParent() == CondPHI->getParent())
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, if the PHI and select are defined in the same block and if V is
|
|
// defined in a different block, then we can transform it.
|
|
if (SI.getParent() == CondPHI->getParent() &&
|
|
I->getParent() != CondPHI->getParent())
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise we have a 'hard' case and we can't tell without doing more
|
|
// detailed dominator based analysis, punt.
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldSPFofSPF - We have an SPF (e.g. a min or max) of an SPF of the form:
|
|
/// SPF2(SPF1(A, B), C)
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldSPFofSPF(Instruction *Inner,
|
|
SelectPatternFlavor SPF1,
|
|
Value *A, Value *B,
|
|
Instruction &Outer,
|
|
SelectPatternFlavor SPF2, Value *C) {
|
|
if (C == A || C == B) {
|
|
// MAX(MAX(A, B), B) -> MAX(A, B)
|
|
// MIN(MIN(a, b), a) -> MIN(a, b)
|
|
if (SPF1 == SPF2)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(Outer, Inner);
|
|
|
|
// MAX(MIN(a, b), a) -> a
|
|
// MIN(MAX(a, b), a) -> a
|
|
if ((SPF1 == SPF_SMIN && SPF2 == SPF_SMAX) ||
|
|
(SPF1 == SPF_SMAX && SPF2 == SPF_SMIN) ||
|
|
(SPF1 == SPF_UMIN && SPF2 == SPF_UMAX) ||
|
|
(SPF1 == SPF_UMAX && SPF2 == SPF_UMIN))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(Outer, C);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// TODO: MIN(MIN(A, 23), 97)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSelectInst(SelectInst &SI) {
|
|
Value *CondVal = SI.getCondition();
|
|
Value *TrueVal = SI.getTrueValue();
|
|
Value *FalseVal = SI.getFalseValue();
|
|
|
|
// select true, X, Y -> X
|
|
// select false, X, Y -> Y
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(CondVal))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, C->getZExtValue() ? TrueVal : FalseVal);
|
|
|
|
// select C, X, X -> X
|
|
if (TrueVal == FalseVal)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(TrueVal)) // select C, undef, X -> X
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(FalseVal)) // select C, X, undef -> X
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(CondVal)) { // select undef, X, Y -> X or Y
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(TrueVal))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
else
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (SI.getType() == Type::getInt1Ty(SI.getContext())) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal)) {
|
|
if (C->getZExtValue()) {
|
|
// Change: A = select B, true, C --> A = or B, C
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Change: A = select B, false, C --> A = and !B, C
|
|
Value *NotCond =
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
|
|
"not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(NotCond, FalseVal);
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
|
|
if (C->getZExtValue() == false) {
|
|
// Change: A = select B, C, false --> A = and B, C
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Change: A = select B, C, true --> A = or !B, C
|
|
Value *NotCond =
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
|
|
"not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(NotCond, TrueVal);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// select a, b, a -> a&b
|
|
// select a, a, b -> a|b
|
|
if (CondVal == TrueVal)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateOr(CondVal, FalseVal);
|
|
else if (CondVal == FalseVal)
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAnd(CondVal, TrueVal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Selecting between two integer constants?
|
|
if (ConstantInt *TrueValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(TrueVal))
|
|
if (ConstantInt *FalseValC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(FalseVal)) {
|
|
// select C, 1, 0 -> zext C to int
|
|
if (FalseValC->isZero() && TrueValC->getValue() == 1) {
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, CondVal, SI.getType());
|
|
} else if (TrueValC->isZero() && FalseValC->getValue() == 1) {
|
|
// select C, 0, 1 -> zext !C to int
|
|
Value *NotCond =
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::CreateNot(CondVal,
|
|
"not."+CondVal->getName()), SI);
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Instruction::ZExt, NotCond, SI.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (ICmpInst *IC = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(SI.getCondition())) {
|
|
// If one of the constants is zero (we know they can't both be) and we
|
|
// have an icmp instruction with zero, and we have an 'and' with the
|
|
// non-constant value, eliminate this whole mess. This corresponds to
|
|
// cases like this: ((X & 27) ? 27 : 0)
|
|
if (TrueValC->isZero() || FalseValC->isZero())
|
|
if (IC->isEquality() && isa<ConstantInt>(IC->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
cast<Constant>(IC->getOperand(1))->isNullValue())
|
|
if (Instruction *ICA = dyn_cast<Instruction>(IC->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (ICA->getOpcode() == Instruction::And &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
(ICA->getOperand(1) == TrueValC ||
|
|
ICA->getOperand(1) == FalseValC) &&
|
|
isOneBitSet(cast<ConstantInt>(ICA->getOperand(1)))) {
|
|
// Okay, now we know that everything is set up, we just don't
|
|
// know whether we have a icmp_ne or icmp_eq and whether the
|
|
// true or false val is the zero.
|
|
bool ShouldNotVal = !TrueValC->isZero();
|
|
ShouldNotVal ^= IC->getPredicate() == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE;
|
|
Value *V = ICA;
|
|
if (ShouldNotVal)
|
|
V = InsertNewInstBefore(BinaryOperator::Create(
|
|
Instruction::Xor, V, ICA->getOperand(1)), SI);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, V);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
|
|
if (FCmpInst *FCI = dyn_cast<FCmpInst>(CondVal)) {
|
|
if (FCI->getOperand(0) == TrueVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == FalseVal) {
|
|
// Transform (X == Y) ? X : Y -> Y
|
|
if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
|
|
// This is not safe in general for floating point:
|
|
// consider X== -0, Y== +0.
|
|
// It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
|
|
ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
|
|
if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
|
|
!CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
|
|
((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
|
|
!CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
}
|
|
// Transform (X != Y) ? X : Y -> X
|
|
if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
|
|
|
|
} else if (FCI->getOperand(0) == FalseVal && FCI->getOperand(1) == TrueVal){
|
|
// Transform (X == Y) ? Y : X -> X
|
|
if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_OEQ) {
|
|
// This is not safe in general for floating point:
|
|
// consider X== -0, Y== +0.
|
|
// It becomes safe if either operand is a nonzero constant.
|
|
ConstantFP *CFPt, *CFPf;
|
|
if (((CFPt = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(TrueVal)) &&
|
|
!CFPt->getValueAPF().isZero()) ||
|
|
((CFPf = dyn_cast<ConstantFP>(FalseVal)) &&
|
|
!CFPf->getValueAPF().isZero()))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, FalseVal);
|
|
}
|
|
// Transform (X != Y) ? Y : X -> Y
|
|
if (FCI->getPredicate() == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SI, TrueVal);
|
|
// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect MIN/MAX
|
|
}
|
|
// NOTE: if we wanted to, this is where to detect ABS
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we are selecting two values based on a comparison of the two values.
|
|
if (ICmpInst *ICI = dyn_cast<ICmpInst>(CondVal))
|
|
if (Instruction *Result = visitSelectInstWithICmp(SI, ICI))
|
|
return Result;
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *TI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(TrueVal))
|
|
if (Instruction *FI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(FalseVal))
|
|
if (TI->hasOneUse() && FI->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Instruction *AddOp = 0, *SubOp = 0;
|
|
|
|
// Turn (select C, (op X, Y), (op X, Z)) -> (op X, (select C, Y, Z))
|
|
if (TI->getOpcode() == FI->getOpcode())
|
|
if (Instruction *IV = FoldSelectOpOp(SI, TI, FI))
|
|
return IV;
|
|
|
|
// Turn select C, (X+Y), (X-Y) --> (X+(select C, Y, (-Y))). This is
|
|
// even legal for FP.
|
|
if ((TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
|
|
FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
|
|
(TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
|
|
FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
|
|
AddOp = FI; SubOp = TI;
|
|
} else if ((FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Sub &&
|
|
TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add) ||
|
|
(FI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FSub &&
|
|
TI->getOpcode() == Instruction::FAdd)) {
|
|
AddOp = TI; SubOp = FI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (AddOp) {
|
|
Value *OtherAddOp = 0;
|
|
if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(0)) {
|
|
OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(1);
|
|
} else if (SubOp->getOperand(0) == AddOp->getOperand(1)) {
|
|
OtherAddOp = AddOp->getOperand(0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (OtherAddOp) {
|
|
// So at this point we know we have (Y -> OtherAddOp):
|
|
// select C, (add X, Y), (sub X, Z)
|
|
Value *NegVal; // Compute -Z
|
|
if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SubOp->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
NegVal = ConstantExpr::getNeg(C);
|
|
} else {
|
|
NegVal = InsertNewInstBefore(
|
|
BinaryOperator::CreateNeg(SubOp->getOperand(1),
|
|
"tmp"), SI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *NewTrueOp = OtherAddOp;
|
|
Value *NewFalseOp = NegVal;
|
|
if (AddOp != TI)
|
|
std::swap(NewTrueOp, NewFalseOp);
|
|
Instruction *NewSel =
|
|
SelectInst::Create(CondVal, NewTrueOp,
|
|
NewFalseOp, SI.getName() + ".p");
|
|
|
|
NewSel = InsertNewInstBefore(NewSel, SI);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(SubOp->getOperand(0), NewSel);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we can fold the select into one of our operands.
|
|
if (SI.getType()->isInteger()) {
|
|
if (Instruction *FoldI = FoldSelectIntoOp(SI, TrueVal, FalseVal))
|
|
return FoldI;
|
|
|
|
// MAX(MAX(a, b), a) -> MAX(a, b)
|
|
// MIN(MIN(a, b), a) -> MIN(a, b)
|
|
// MAX(MIN(a, b), a) -> a
|
|
// MIN(MAX(a, b), a) -> a
|
|
Value *LHS, *RHS, *LHS2, *RHS2;
|
|
if (SelectPatternFlavor SPF = MatchSelectPattern(&SI, LHS, RHS)) {
|
|
if (SelectPatternFlavor SPF2 = MatchSelectPattern(LHS, LHS2, RHS2))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldSPFofSPF(cast<Instruction>(LHS),SPF2,LHS2,RHS2,
|
|
SI, SPF, RHS))
|
|
return R;
|
|
if (SelectPatternFlavor SPF2 = MatchSelectPattern(RHS, LHS2, RHS2))
|
|
if (Instruction *R = FoldSPFofSPF(cast<Instruction>(RHS),SPF2,LHS2,RHS2,
|
|
SI, SPF, LHS))
|
|
return R;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// TODO.
|
|
// ABS(-X) -> ABS(X)
|
|
// ABS(ABS(X)) -> ABS(X)
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we can fold the select into a phi node if the condition is a select.
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(SI.getCondition()))
|
|
// The true/false values have to be live in the PHI predecessor's blocks.
|
|
if (CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(TrueVal, SI) &&
|
|
CanSelectOperandBeMappingIntoPredBlock(FalseVal, SI))
|
|
if (Instruction *NV = FoldOpIntoPhi(SI))
|
|
return NV;
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator::isNot(CondVal)) {
|
|
SI.setOperand(0, BinaryOperator::getNotArgument(CondVal));
|
|
SI.setOperand(1, FalseVal);
|
|
SI.setOperand(2, TrueVal);
|
|
return &SI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// EnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer points to an object that
|
|
/// we control, modify the object's alignment to PrefAlign. This isn't
|
|
/// often possible though. If alignment is important, a more reliable approach
|
|
/// is to simply align all global variables and allocation instructions to
|
|
/// their preferred alignment from the beginning.
|
|
///
|
|
static unsigned EnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
|
|
unsigned Align, unsigned PrefAlign) {
|
|
|
|
User *U = dyn_cast<User>(V);
|
|
if (!U) return Align;
|
|
|
|
switch (Operator::getOpcode(U)) {
|
|
default: break;
|
|
case Instruction::BitCast:
|
|
return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
|
|
case Instruction::GetElementPtr: {
|
|
// If all indexes are zero, it is just the alignment of the base pointer.
|
|
bool AllZeroOperands = true;
|
|
for (User::op_iterator i = U->op_begin() + 1, e = U->op_end(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
if (!isa<Constant>(*i) ||
|
|
!cast<Constant>(*i)->isNullValue()) {
|
|
AllZeroOperands = false;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (AllZeroOperands) {
|
|
// Treat this like a bitcast.
|
|
return EnforceKnownAlignment(U->getOperand(0), Align, PrefAlign);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (GlobalValue *GV = dyn_cast<GlobalValue>(V)) {
|
|
// If there is a large requested alignment and we can, bump up the alignment
|
|
// of the global.
|
|
if (!GV->isDeclaration()) {
|
|
if (GV->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
|
|
Align = GV->getAlignment();
|
|
else {
|
|
GV->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
|
|
Align = PrefAlign;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(V)) {
|
|
// If there is a requested alignment and if this is an alloca, round up.
|
|
if (AI->getAlignment() >= PrefAlign)
|
|
Align = AI->getAlignment();
|
|
else {
|
|
AI->setAlignment(PrefAlign);
|
|
Align = PrefAlign;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Align;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment - If the specified pointer has an alignment that
|
|
/// we can determine, return it, otherwise return 0. If PrefAlign is specified,
|
|
/// and it is more than the alignment of the ultimate object, see if we can
|
|
/// increase the alignment of the ultimate object, making this check succeed.
|
|
unsigned InstCombiner::GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Value *V,
|
|
unsigned PrefAlign) {
|
|
unsigned BitWidth = TD ? TD->getTypeSizeInBits(V->getType()) :
|
|
sizeof(PrefAlign) * CHAR_BIT;
|
|
APInt Mask = APInt::getAllOnesValue(BitWidth);
|
|
APInt KnownZero(BitWidth, 0), KnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
|
|
ComputeMaskedBits(V, Mask, KnownZero, KnownOne);
|
|
unsigned TrailZ = KnownZero.countTrailingOnes();
|
|
unsigned Align = 1u << std::min(BitWidth - 1, TrailZ);
|
|
|
|
if (PrefAlign > Align)
|
|
Align = EnforceKnownAlignment(V, Align, PrefAlign);
|
|
|
|
// We don't need to make any adjustment.
|
|
return Align;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemTransfer(MemIntrinsic *MI) {
|
|
unsigned DstAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(1));
|
|
unsigned SrcAlign = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getOperand(2));
|
|
unsigned MinAlign = std::min(DstAlign, SrcAlign);
|
|
unsigned CopyAlign = MI->getAlignment();
|
|
|
|
if (CopyAlign < MinAlign) {
|
|
MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
|
|
MinAlign, false));
|
|
return MI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If MemCpyInst length is 1/2/4/8 bytes then replace memcpy with
|
|
// load/store.
|
|
ConstantInt *MemOpLength = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getOperand(3));
|
|
if (MemOpLength == 0) return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Source and destination pointer types are always "i8*" for intrinsic. See
|
|
// if the size is something we can handle with a single primitive load/store.
|
|
// A single load+store correctly handles overlapping memory in the memmove
|
|
// case.
|
|
unsigned Size = MemOpLength->getZExtValue();
|
|
if (Size == 0) return MI; // Delete this mem transfer.
|
|
|
|
if (Size > 8 || (Size&(Size-1)))
|
|
return 0; // If not 1/2/4/8 bytes, exit.
|
|
|
|
// Use an integer load+store unless we can find something better.
|
|
Type *NewPtrTy =
|
|
PointerType::getUnqual(IntegerType::get(MI->getContext(), Size<<3));
|
|
|
|
// Memcpy forces the use of i8* for the source and destination. That means
|
|
// that if you're using memcpy to move one double around, you'll get a cast
|
|
// from double* to i8*. We'd much rather use a double load+store rather than
|
|
// an i64 load+store, here because this improves the odds that the source or
|
|
// dest address will be promotable. See if we can find a better type than the
|
|
// integer datatype.
|
|
if (Value *Op = getBitCastOperand(MI->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
const Type *SrcETy = cast<PointerType>(Op->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
if (TD && SrcETy->isSized() && TD->getTypeStoreSize(SrcETy) == Size) {
|
|
// The SrcETy might be something like {{{double}}} or [1 x double]. Rip
|
|
// down through these levels if so.
|
|
while (!SrcETy->isSingleValueType()) {
|
|
if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcETy)) {
|
|
if (STy->getNumElements() == 1)
|
|
SrcETy = STy->getElementType(0);
|
|
else
|
|
break;
|
|
} else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcETy)) {
|
|
if (ATy->getNumElements() == 1)
|
|
SrcETy = ATy->getElementType();
|
|
else
|
|
break;
|
|
} else
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (SrcETy->isSingleValueType())
|
|
NewPtrTy = PointerType::getUnqual(SrcETy);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// If the memcpy/memmove provides better alignment info than we can
|
|
// infer, use it.
|
|
SrcAlign = std::max(SrcAlign, CopyAlign);
|
|
DstAlign = std::max(DstAlign, CopyAlign);
|
|
|
|
Value *Src = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(2), NewPtrTy);
|
|
Value *Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(MI->getOperand(1), NewPtrTy);
|
|
Instruction *L = new LoadInst(Src, "tmp", false, SrcAlign);
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(L, *MI);
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(L, Dest, false, DstAlign), *MI);
|
|
|
|
// Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
|
|
MI->setOperand(3, Constant::getNullValue(MemOpLength->getType()));
|
|
return MI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::SimplifyMemSet(MemSetInst *MI) {
|
|
unsigned Alignment = GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(MI->getDest());
|
|
if (MI->getAlignment() < Alignment) {
|
|
MI->setAlignment(ConstantInt::get(MI->getAlignmentType(),
|
|
Alignment, false));
|
|
return MI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Extract the length and alignment and fill if they are constant.
|
|
ConstantInt *LenC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getLength());
|
|
ConstantInt *FillC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(MI->getValue());
|
|
if (!LenC || !FillC || FillC->getType() != Type::getInt8Ty(MI->getContext()))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
uint64_t Len = LenC->getZExtValue();
|
|
Alignment = MI->getAlignment();
|
|
|
|
// If the length is zero, this is a no-op
|
|
if (Len == 0) return MI; // memset(d,c,0,a) -> noop
|
|
|
|
// memset(s,c,n) -> store s, c (for n=1,2,4,8)
|
|
if (Len <= 8 && isPowerOf2_32((uint32_t)Len)) {
|
|
const Type *ITy = IntegerType::get(MI->getContext(), Len*8); // n=1 -> i8.
|
|
|
|
Value *Dest = MI->getDest();
|
|
Dest = Builder->CreateBitCast(Dest, PointerType::getUnqual(ITy));
|
|
|
|
// Alignment 0 is identity for alignment 1 for memset, but not store.
|
|
if (Alignment == 0) Alignment = 1;
|
|
|
|
// Extract the fill value and store.
|
|
uint64_t Fill = FillC->getZExtValue()*0x0101010101010101ULL;
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(ConstantInt::get(ITy, Fill),
|
|
Dest, false, Alignment), *MI);
|
|
|
|
// Set the size of the copy to 0, it will be deleted on the next iteration.
|
|
MI->setLength(Constant::getNullValue(LenC->getType()));
|
|
return MI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// visitCallInst - CallInst simplification. This mostly only handles folding
|
|
/// of intrinsic instructions. For normal calls, it allows visitCallSite to do
|
|
/// the heavy lifting.
|
|
///
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallInst(CallInst &CI) {
|
|
if (isFreeCall(&CI))
|
|
return visitFree(CI);
|
|
|
|
// If the caller function is nounwind, mark the call as nounwind, even if the
|
|
// callee isn't.
|
|
if (CI.getParent()->getParent()->doesNotThrow() &&
|
|
!CI.doesNotThrow()) {
|
|
CI.setDoesNotThrow();
|
|
return &CI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(&CI);
|
|
if (!II) return visitCallSite(&CI);
|
|
|
|
// Intrinsics cannot occur in an invoke, so handle them here instead of in
|
|
// visitCallSite.
|
|
if (MemIntrinsic *MI = dyn_cast<MemIntrinsic>(II)) {
|
|
bool Changed = false;
|
|
|
|
// memmove/cpy/set of zero bytes is a noop.
|
|
if (Constant *NumBytes = dyn_cast<Constant>(MI->getLength())) {
|
|
if (NumBytes->isNullValue()) return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(NumBytes))
|
|
if (CI->getZExtValue() == 1) {
|
|
// Replace the instruction with just byte operations. We would
|
|
// transform other cases to loads/stores, but we don't know if
|
|
// alignment is sufficient.
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we have a memmove and the source operation is a constant global,
|
|
// then the source and dest pointers can't alias, so we can change this
|
|
// into a call to memcpy.
|
|
if (MemMoveInst *MMI = dyn_cast<MemMoveInst>(MI)) {
|
|
if (GlobalVariable *GVSrc = dyn_cast<GlobalVariable>(MMI->getSource()))
|
|
if (GVSrc->isConstant()) {
|
|
Module *M = CI.getParent()->getParent()->getParent();
|
|
Intrinsic::ID MemCpyID = Intrinsic::memcpy;
|
|
const Type *Tys[1];
|
|
Tys[0] = CI.getOperand(3)->getType();
|
|
CI.setOperand(0,
|
|
Intrinsic::getDeclaration(M, MemCpyID, Tys, 1));
|
|
Changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (MemTransferInst *MTI = dyn_cast<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
|
|
// memmove(x,x,size) -> noop.
|
|
if (MTI->getSource() == MTI->getDest())
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we can determine a pointer alignment that is bigger than currently
|
|
// set, update the alignment.
|
|
if (isa<MemTransferInst>(MI)) {
|
|
if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemTransfer(MI))
|
|
return I;
|
|
} else if (MemSetInst *MSI = dyn_cast<MemSetInst>(MI)) {
|
|
if (Instruction *I = SimplifyMemSet(MSI))
|
|
return I;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Changed) return II;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
|
|
default: break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::bswap:
|
|
// bswap(bswap(x)) -> x
|
|
if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Operand->getOperand(1));
|
|
|
|
// bswap(trunc(bswap(x))) -> trunc(lshr(x, c))
|
|
if (TruncInst *TI = dyn_cast<TruncInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (IntrinsicInst *Operand = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(TI->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (Operand->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::bswap) {
|
|
unsigned C = Operand->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() -
|
|
TI->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
|
|
Value *CV = ConstantInt::get(Operand->getType(), C);
|
|
Value *V = Builder->CreateLShr(Operand->getOperand(1), CV);
|
|
return new TruncInst(V, TI->getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::powi:
|
|
if (ConstantInt *Power = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
// powi(x, 0) -> 1.0
|
|
if (Power->isZero())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, ConstantFP::get(CI.getType(), 1.0));
|
|
// powi(x, 1) -> x
|
|
if (Power->isOne())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, II->getOperand(1));
|
|
// powi(x, -1) -> 1/x
|
|
if (Power->isAllOnesValue())
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateFDiv(ConstantFP::get(CI.getType(), 1.0),
|
|
II->getOperand(1));
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow: {
|
|
Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
|
|
const IntegerType *IT = cast<IntegerType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
|
|
uint32_t BitWidth = IT->getBitWidth();
|
|
APInt Mask = APInt::getSignBit(BitWidth);
|
|
APInt LHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0);
|
|
APInt LHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
|
|
ComputeMaskedBits(LHS, Mask, LHSKnownZero, LHSKnownOne);
|
|
bool LHSKnownNegative = LHSKnownOne[BitWidth - 1];
|
|
bool LHSKnownPositive = LHSKnownZero[BitWidth - 1];
|
|
|
|
if (LHSKnownNegative || LHSKnownPositive) {
|
|
APInt RHSKnownZero(BitWidth, 0);
|
|
APInt RHSKnownOne(BitWidth, 0);
|
|
ComputeMaskedBits(RHS, Mask, RHSKnownZero, RHSKnownOne);
|
|
bool RHSKnownNegative = RHSKnownOne[BitWidth - 1];
|
|
bool RHSKnownPositive = RHSKnownZero[BitWidth - 1];
|
|
if (LHSKnownNegative && RHSKnownNegative) {
|
|
// The sign bit is set in both cases: this MUST overflow.
|
|
// Create a simple add instruction, and insert it into the struct.
|
|
Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHS, RHS, "", &CI);
|
|
Worklist.Add(Add);
|
|
Constant *V[] = {
|
|
UndefValue::get(LHS->getType()),ConstantInt::getTrue(II->getContext())
|
|
};
|
|
Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(II->getContext(), V, 2, false);
|
|
return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, Add, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (LHSKnownPositive && RHSKnownPositive) {
|
|
// The sign bit is clear in both cases: this CANNOT overflow.
|
|
// Create a simple add instruction, and insert it into the struct.
|
|
Instruction *Add = BinaryOperator::CreateNUWAdd(LHS, RHS, "", &CI);
|
|
Worklist.Add(Add);
|
|
Constant *V[] = {
|
|
UndefValue::get(LHS->getType()),
|
|
ConstantInt::getFalse(II->getContext())
|
|
};
|
|
Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(II->getContext(), V, 2, false);
|
|
return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, Add, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// FALL THROUGH uadd into sadd
|
|
case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
|
|
// Canonicalize constants into the RHS.
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
!isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
|
|
II->setOperand(1, II->getOperand(2));
|
|
II->setOperand(2, LHS);
|
|
return II;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// X + undef -> undef
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
// X + 0 -> {X, false}
|
|
if (RHS->isZero()) {
|
|
Constant *V[] = {
|
|
UndefValue::get(II->getOperand(0)->getType()),
|
|
ConstantInt::getFalse(II->getContext())
|
|
};
|
|
Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(II->getContext(), V, 2, false);
|
|
return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, II->getOperand(1), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
|
|
case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
|
|
// undef - X -> undef
|
|
// X - undef -> undef
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(1)) ||
|
|
isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
// X - 0 -> {X, false}
|
|
if (RHS->isZero()) {
|
|
Constant *V[] = {
|
|
UndefValue::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType()),
|
|
ConstantInt::getFalse(II->getContext())
|
|
};
|
|
Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(II->getContext(), V, 2, false);
|
|
return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, II->getOperand(1), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
|
|
case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
|
|
// Canonicalize constants into the RHS.
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
!isa<Constant>(II->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1);
|
|
II->setOperand(1, II->getOperand(2));
|
|
II->setOperand(2, LHS);
|
|
return II;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// X * undef -> undef
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(II->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantInt *RHSI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(II->getOperand(2))) {
|
|
// X*0 -> {0, false}
|
|
if (RHSI->isZero())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(CI, Constant::getNullValue(II->getType()));
|
|
|
|
// X * 1 -> {X, false}
|
|
if (RHSI->equalsInt(1)) {
|
|
Constant *V[] = {
|
|
UndefValue::get(II->getOperand(1)->getType()),
|
|
ConstantInt::getFalse(II->getContext())
|
|
};
|
|
Constant *Struct = ConstantStruct::get(II->getContext(), V, 2, false);
|
|
return InsertValueInst::Create(Struct, II->getOperand(1), 0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvx:
|
|
case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_lvxl:
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse_loadu_ps:
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_pd:
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_loadu_dq:
|
|
// Turn PPC lvx -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
|
|
// Turn X86 loadups -> load if the pointer is known aligned.
|
|
if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
|
|
Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1),
|
|
PointerType::getUnqual(II->getType()));
|
|
return new LoadInst(Ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvx:
|
|
case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_stvxl:
|
|
// Turn stvx -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
|
|
if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(2), 16) >= 16) {
|
|
const Type *OpPtrTy =
|
|
PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(1)->getType());
|
|
Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), OpPtrTy);
|
|
return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(1), Ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse_storeu_ps:
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_pd:
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse2_storeu_dq:
|
|
// Turn X86 storeu -> store if the pointer is known aligned.
|
|
if (GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(II->getOperand(1), 16) >= 16) {
|
|
const Type *OpPtrTy =
|
|
PointerType::getUnqual(II->getOperand(2)->getType());
|
|
Value *Ptr = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), OpPtrTy);
|
|
return new StoreInst(II->getOperand(2), Ptr);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Intrinsic::x86_sse_cvttss2si: {
|
|
// These intrinsics only demands the 0th element of its input vector. If
|
|
// we can simplify the input based on that, do so now.
|
|
unsigned VWidth =
|
|
cast<VectorType>(II->getOperand(1)->getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
APInt DemandedElts(VWidth, 1);
|
|
APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
|
|
if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(II->getOperand(1), DemandedElts,
|
|
UndefElts)) {
|
|
II->setOperand(1, V);
|
|
return II;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
case Intrinsic::ppc_altivec_vperm:
|
|
// Turn vperm(V1,V2,mask) -> shuffle(V1,V2,mask) if mask is a constant.
|
|
if (ConstantVector *Mask = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(II->getOperand(3))) {
|
|
assert(Mask->getNumOperands() == 16 && "Bad type for intrinsic!");
|
|
|
|
// Check that all of the elements are integer constants or undefs.
|
|
bool AllEltsOk = true;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
|
|
if (!isa<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i)) &&
|
|
!isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i))) {
|
|
AllEltsOk = false;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (AllEltsOk) {
|
|
// Cast the input vectors to byte vectors.
|
|
Value *Op0 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(1), Mask->getType());
|
|
Value *Op1 = Builder->CreateBitCast(II->getOperand(2), Mask->getType());
|
|
Value *Result = UndefValue::get(Op0->getType());
|
|
|
|
// Only extract each element once.
|
|
Value *ExtractedElts[32];
|
|
memset(ExtractedElts, 0, sizeof(ExtractedElts));
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != 16; ++i) {
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Mask->getOperand(i)))
|
|
continue;
|
|
unsigned Idx=cast<ConstantInt>(Mask->getOperand(i))->getZExtValue();
|
|
Idx &= 31; // Match the hardware behavior.
|
|
|
|
if (ExtractedElts[Idx] == 0) {
|
|
ExtractedElts[Idx] =
|
|
Builder->CreateExtractElement(Idx < 16 ? Op0 : Op1,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(II->getContext()),
|
|
Idx&15, false), "tmp");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Insert this value into the result vector.
|
|
Result = Builder->CreateInsertElement(Result, ExtractedElts[Idx],
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(II->getContext()),
|
|
i, false), "tmp");
|
|
}
|
|
return CastInst::Create(Instruction::BitCast, Result, CI.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
case Intrinsic::stackrestore: {
|
|
// If the save is right next to the restore, remove the restore. This can
|
|
// happen when variable allocas are DCE'd.
|
|
if (IntrinsicInst *SS = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(II->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
if (SS->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stacksave) {
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BI = SS;
|
|
if (&*++BI == II)
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Scan down this block to see if there is another stack restore in the
|
|
// same block without an intervening call/alloca.
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BI = II;
|
|
TerminatorInst *TI = II->getParent()->getTerminator();
|
|
bool CannotRemove = false;
|
|
for (++BI; &*BI != TI; ++BI) {
|
|
if (isa<AllocaInst>(BI) || isMalloc(BI)) {
|
|
CannotRemove = true;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (CallInst *BCI = dyn_cast<CallInst>(BI)) {
|
|
if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BCI)) {
|
|
// If there is a stackrestore below this one, remove this one.
|
|
if (II->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::stackrestore)
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
|
|
// Otherwise, ignore the intrinsic.
|
|
} else {
|
|
// If we found a non-intrinsic call, we can't remove the stack
|
|
// restore.
|
|
CannotRemove = true;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the stack restore is in a return/unwind block and if there are no
|
|
// allocas or calls between the restore and the return, nuke the restore.
|
|
if (!CannotRemove && (isa<ReturnInst>(TI) || isa<UnwindInst>(TI)))
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(CI);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return visitCallSite(II);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// InvokeInst simplification
|
|
//
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInvokeInst(InvokeInst &II) {
|
|
return visitCallSite(&II);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast - If this cast does not affect the value
|
|
/// passed through the varargs area, we can eliminate the use of the cast.
|
|
static bool isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(const CallSite CS,
|
|
const CastInst * const CI,
|
|
const TargetData * const TD,
|
|
const int ix) {
|
|
if (!CI->isLosslessCast())
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// The size of ByVal arguments is derived from the type, so we
|
|
// can't change to a type with a different size. If the size were
|
|
// passed explicitly we could avoid this check.
|
|
if (!CS.paramHasAttr(ix, Attribute::ByVal))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
const Type* SrcTy =
|
|
cast<PointerType>(CI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
const Type* DstTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
if (!SrcTy->isSized() || !DstTy->isSized())
|
|
return false;
|
|
if (!TD || TD->getTypeAllocSize(SrcTy) != TD->getTypeAllocSize(DstTy))
|
|
return false;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// visitCallSite - Improvements for call and invoke instructions.
|
|
//
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitCallSite(CallSite CS) {
|
|
bool Changed = false;
|
|
|
|
// If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function, attempt to move the cast
|
|
// to the arguments of the call/invoke.
|
|
if (transformConstExprCastCall(CS)) return 0;
|
|
|
|
Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
|
|
|
|
if (Function *CalleeF = dyn_cast<Function>(Callee))
|
|
if (CalleeF->getCallingConv() != CS.getCallingConv()) {
|
|
Instruction *OldCall = CS.getInstruction();
|
|
// If the call and callee calling conventions don't match, this call must
|
|
// be unreachable, as the call is undefined.
|
|
new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(Callee->getContext()),
|
|
UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(Callee->getContext())),
|
|
OldCall);
|
|
// If OldCall dues not return void then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
|
|
// This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
|
|
if (!OldCall->getType()->isVoidTy())
|
|
OldCall->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(OldCall->getType()));
|
|
if (isa<CallInst>(OldCall)) // Not worth removing an invoke here.
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(*OldCall);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Callee) || isa<UndefValue>(Callee)) {
|
|
// This instruction is not reachable, just remove it. We insert a store to
|
|
// undef so that we know that this code is not reachable, despite the fact
|
|
// that we can't modify the CFG here.
|
|
new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(Callee->getContext()),
|
|
UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(Callee->getContext())),
|
|
CS.getInstruction());
|
|
|
|
// If CS dues not return void then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
|
|
// This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
|
|
if (!CS.getInstruction()->getType()->isVoidTy())
|
|
CS.getInstruction()->
|
|
replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(CS.getInstruction()->getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(CS.getInstruction())) {
|
|
// Don't break the CFG, insert a dummy cond branch.
|
|
BranchInst::Create(II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
|
|
ConstantInt::getTrue(Callee->getContext()), II);
|
|
}
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(*CS.getInstruction());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (BitCastInst *BC = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(Callee))
|
|
if (IntrinsicInst *In = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(BC->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (In->getIntrinsicID() == Intrinsic::init_trampoline)
|
|
return transformCallThroughTrampoline(CS);
|
|
|
|
const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
|
|
const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
|
|
if (FTy->isVarArg()) {
|
|
int ix = FTy->getNumParams() + (isa<InvokeInst>(Callee) ? 3 : 1);
|
|
// See if we can optimize any arguments passed through the varargs area of
|
|
// the call.
|
|
for (CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin()+FTy->getNumParams(),
|
|
E = CS.arg_end(); I != E; ++I, ++ix) {
|
|
CastInst *CI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(*I);
|
|
if (CI && isSafeToEliminateVarargsCast(CS, CI, TD, ix)) {
|
|
*I = CI->getOperand(0);
|
|
Changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (isa<InlineAsm>(Callee) && !CS.doesNotThrow()) {
|
|
// Inline asm calls cannot throw - mark them 'nounwind'.
|
|
CS.setDoesNotThrow();
|
|
Changed = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return Changed ? CS.getInstruction() : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// transformConstExprCastCall - If the callee is a constexpr cast of a function,
|
|
// attempt to move the cast to the arguments of the call/invoke.
|
|
//
|
|
bool InstCombiner::transformConstExprCastCall(CallSite CS) {
|
|
if (!isa<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue())) return false;
|
|
ConstantExpr *CE = cast<ConstantExpr>(CS.getCalledValue());
|
|
if (CE->getOpcode() != Instruction::BitCast ||
|
|
!isa<Function>(CE->getOperand(0)))
|
|
return false;
|
|
Function *Callee = cast<Function>(CE->getOperand(0));
|
|
Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
|
|
const AttrListPtr &CallerPAL = CS.getAttributes();
|
|
|
|
// Okay, this is a cast from a function to a different type. Unless doing so
|
|
// would cause a type conversion of one of our arguments, change this call to
|
|
// be a direct call with arguments casted to the appropriate types.
|
|
//
|
|
const FunctionType *FT = Callee->getFunctionType();
|
|
const Type *OldRetTy = Caller->getType();
|
|
const Type *NewRetTy = FT->getReturnType();
|
|
|
|
if (isa<StructType>(NewRetTy))
|
|
return false; // TODO: Handle multiple return values.
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if we are changing the return type...
|
|
if (OldRetTy != NewRetTy) {
|
|
if (Callee->isDeclaration() &&
|
|
// Conversion is ok if changing from one pointer type to another or from
|
|
// a pointer to an integer of the same size.
|
|
!((isa<PointerType>(OldRetTy) || !TD ||
|
|
OldRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
|
|
(isa<PointerType>(NewRetTy) || !TD ||
|
|
NewRetTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))))
|
|
return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
|
|
|
|
if (!Caller->use_empty() &&
|
|
// void -> non-void is handled specially
|
|
!NewRetTy->isVoidTy() && !CastInst::isCastable(NewRetTy, OldRetTy))
|
|
return false; // Cannot transform this return value.
|
|
|
|
if (!CallerPAL.isEmpty() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
|
|
Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
|
|
if (RAttrs & Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy))
|
|
return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the callsite is an invoke instruction, and the return value is used by
|
|
// a PHI node in a successor, we cannot change the return type of the call
|
|
// because there is no place to put the cast instruction (without breaking
|
|
// the critical edge). Bail out in this case.
|
|
if (!Caller->use_empty())
|
|
if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller))
|
|
for (Value::use_iterator UI = II->use_begin(), E = II->use_end();
|
|
UI != E; ++UI)
|
|
if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(*UI))
|
|
if (PN->getParent() == II->getNormalDest() ||
|
|
PN->getParent() == II->getUnwindDest())
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
unsigned NumActualArgs = unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin());
|
|
unsigned NumCommonArgs = std::min(FT->getNumParams(), NumActualArgs);
|
|
|
|
CallSite::arg_iterator AI = CS.arg_begin();
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = NumCommonArgs; i != e; ++i, ++AI) {
|
|
const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
|
|
const Type *ActTy = (*AI)->getType();
|
|
|
|
if (!CastInst::isCastable(ActTy, ParamTy))
|
|
return false; // Cannot transform this parameter value.
|
|
|
|
if (CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1)
|
|
& Attribute::typeIncompatible(ParamTy))
|
|
return false; // Attribute not compatible with transformed value.
|
|
|
|
// Converting from one pointer type to another or between a pointer and an
|
|
// integer of the same size is safe even if we do not have a body.
|
|
bool isConvertible = ActTy == ParamTy ||
|
|
(TD && ((isa<PointerType>(ParamTy) ||
|
|
ParamTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext())) &&
|
|
(isa<PointerType>(ActTy) ||
|
|
ActTy == TD->getIntPtrType(Caller->getContext()))));
|
|
if (Callee->isDeclaration() && !isConvertible) return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && !FT->isVarArg() &&
|
|
Callee->isDeclaration())
|
|
return false; // Do not delete arguments unless we have a function body.
|
|
|
|
if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs && FT->isVarArg() &&
|
|
!CallerPAL.isEmpty())
|
|
// In this case we have more arguments than the new function type, but we
|
|
// won't be dropping them. Check that these extra arguments have attributes
|
|
// that are compatible with being a vararg call argument.
|
|
for (unsigned i = CallerPAL.getNumSlots(); i; --i) {
|
|
if (CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Index <= FT->getNumParams())
|
|
break;
|
|
Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getSlot(i - 1).Attrs;
|
|
if (PAttrs & Attribute::VarArgsIncompatible)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we decided that this is a safe thing to do: go ahead and start
|
|
// inserting cast instructions as necessary...
|
|
std::vector<Value*> Args;
|
|
Args.reserve(NumActualArgs);
|
|
SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> attrVec;
|
|
attrVec.reserve(NumCommonArgs);
|
|
|
|
// Get any return attributes.
|
|
Attributes RAttrs = CallerPAL.getRetAttributes();
|
|
|
|
// If the return value is not being used, the type may not be compatible
|
|
// with the existing attributes. Wipe out any problematic attributes.
|
|
RAttrs &= ~Attribute::typeIncompatible(NewRetTy);
|
|
|
|
// Add the new return attributes.
|
|
if (RAttrs)
|
|
attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, RAttrs));
|
|
|
|
AI = CS.arg_begin();
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumCommonArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
|
|
const Type *ParamTy = FT->getParamType(i);
|
|
if ((*AI)->getType() == ParamTy) {
|
|
Args.push_back(*AI);
|
|
} else {
|
|
Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI,
|
|
false, ParamTy, false);
|
|
Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, ParamTy, "tmp"));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Add any parameter attributes.
|
|
if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
|
|
attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the function takes more arguments than the call was taking, add them
|
|
// now.
|
|
for (unsigned i = NumCommonArgs; i != FT->getNumParams(); ++i)
|
|
Args.push_back(Constant::getNullValue(FT->getParamType(i)));
|
|
|
|
// If we are removing arguments to the function, emit an obnoxious warning.
|
|
if (FT->getNumParams() < NumActualArgs) {
|
|
if (!FT->isVarArg()) {
|
|
errs() << "WARNING: While resolving call to function '"
|
|
<< Callee->getName() << "' arguments were dropped!\n";
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Add all of the arguments in their promoted form to the arg list.
|
|
for (unsigned i = FT->getNumParams(); i != NumActualArgs; ++i, ++AI) {
|
|
const Type *PTy = getPromotedType((*AI)->getType());
|
|
if (PTy != (*AI)->getType()) {
|
|
// Must promote to pass through va_arg area!
|
|
Instruction::CastOps opcode =
|
|
CastInst::getCastOpcode(*AI, false, PTy, false);
|
|
Args.push_back(Builder->CreateCast(opcode, *AI, PTy, "tmp"));
|
|
} else {
|
|
Args.push_back(*AI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Add any parameter attributes.
|
|
if (Attributes PAttrs = CallerPAL.getParamAttributes(i + 1))
|
|
attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(i + 1, PAttrs));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Attributes FnAttrs = CallerPAL.getFnAttributes())
|
|
attrVec.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, FnAttrs));
|
|
|
|
if (NewRetTy->isVoidTy())
|
|
Caller->setName(""); // Void type should not have a name.
|
|
|
|
const AttrListPtr &NewCallerPAL = AttrListPtr::get(attrVec.begin(),
|
|
attrVec.end());
|
|
|
|
Instruction *NC;
|
|
if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
|
|
NC = InvokeInst::Create(Callee, II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
|
|
Args.begin(), Args.end(),
|
|
Caller->getName(), Caller);
|
|
cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
|
|
cast<InvokeInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
|
|
} else {
|
|
NC = CallInst::Create(Callee, Args.begin(), Args.end(),
|
|
Caller->getName(), Caller);
|
|
CallInst *CI = cast<CallInst>(Caller);
|
|
if (CI->isTailCall())
|
|
cast<CallInst>(NC)->setTailCall();
|
|
cast<CallInst>(NC)->setCallingConv(CI->getCallingConv());
|
|
cast<CallInst>(NC)->setAttributes(NewCallerPAL);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Insert a cast of the return type as necessary.
|
|
Value *NV = NC;
|
|
if (OldRetTy != NV->getType() && !Caller->use_empty()) {
|
|
if (!NV->getType()->isVoidTy()) {
|
|
Instruction::CastOps opcode = CastInst::getCastOpcode(NC, false,
|
|
OldRetTy, false);
|
|
NV = NC = CastInst::Create(opcode, NC, OldRetTy, "tmp");
|
|
|
|
// If this is an invoke instruction, we should insert it after the first
|
|
// non-phi, instruction in the normal successor block.
|
|
if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator I = II->getNormalDest()->getFirstNonPHI();
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *I);
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Otherwise, it's a call, just insert cast right after the call instr
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NC, *Caller);
|
|
}
|
|
Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Caller);
|
|
} else {
|
|
NV = UndefValue::get(Caller->getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (!Caller->use_empty())
|
|
Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NV);
|
|
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*Caller);
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// transformCallThroughTrampoline - Turn a call to a function created by the
|
|
// init_trampoline intrinsic into a direct call to the underlying function.
|
|
//
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::transformCallThroughTrampoline(CallSite CS) {
|
|
Value *Callee = CS.getCalledValue();
|
|
const PointerType *PTy = cast<PointerType>(Callee->getType());
|
|
const FunctionType *FTy = cast<FunctionType>(PTy->getElementType());
|
|
const AttrListPtr &Attrs = CS.getAttributes();
|
|
|
|
// If the call already has the 'nest' attribute somewhere then give up -
|
|
// otherwise 'nest' would occur twice after splicing in the chain.
|
|
if (Attrs.hasAttrSomewhere(Attribute::Nest))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
IntrinsicInst *Tramp =
|
|
cast<IntrinsicInst>(cast<BitCastInst>(Callee)->getOperand(0));
|
|
|
|
Function *NestF = cast<Function>(Tramp->getOperand(2)->stripPointerCasts());
|
|
const PointerType *NestFPTy = cast<PointerType>(NestF->getType());
|
|
const FunctionType *NestFTy = cast<FunctionType>(NestFPTy->getElementType());
|
|
|
|
const AttrListPtr &NestAttrs = NestF->getAttributes();
|
|
if (!NestAttrs.isEmpty()) {
|
|
unsigned NestIdx = 1;
|
|
const Type *NestTy = 0;
|
|
Attributes NestAttr = Attribute::None;
|
|
|
|
// Look for a parameter marked with the 'nest' attribute.
|
|
for (FunctionType::param_iterator I = NestFTy->param_begin(),
|
|
E = NestFTy->param_end(); I != E; ++NestIdx, ++I)
|
|
if (NestAttrs.paramHasAttr(NestIdx, Attribute::Nest)) {
|
|
// Record the parameter type and any other attributes.
|
|
NestTy = *I;
|
|
NestAttr = NestAttrs.getParamAttributes(NestIdx);
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (NestTy) {
|
|
Instruction *Caller = CS.getInstruction();
|
|
std::vector<Value*> NewArgs;
|
|
NewArgs.reserve(unsigned(CS.arg_end()-CS.arg_begin())+1);
|
|
|
|
SmallVector<AttributeWithIndex, 8> NewAttrs;
|
|
NewAttrs.reserve(Attrs.getNumSlots() + 1);
|
|
|
|
// Insert the nest argument into the call argument list, which may
|
|
// mean appending it. Likewise for attributes.
|
|
|
|
// Add any result attributes.
|
|
if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getRetAttributes())
|
|
NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(0, Attr));
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned Idx = 1;
|
|
CallSite::arg_iterator I = CS.arg_begin(), E = CS.arg_end();
|
|
do {
|
|
if (Idx == NestIdx) {
|
|
// Add the chain argument and attributes.
|
|
Value *NestVal = Tramp->getOperand(3);
|
|
if (NestVal->getType() != NestTy)
|
|
NestVal = new BitCastInst(NestVal, NestTy, "nest", Caller);
|
|
NewArgs.push_back(NestVal);
|
|
NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(NestIdx, NestAttr));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (I == E)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
// Add the original argument and attributes.
|
|
NewArgs.push_back(*I);
|
|
if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getParamAttributes(Idx))
|
|
NewAttrs.push_back
|
|
(AttributeWithIndex::get(Idx + (Idx >= NestIdx), Attr));
|
|
|
|
++Idx, ++I;
|
|
} while (1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Add any function attributes.
|
|
if (Attributes Attr = Attrs.getFnAttributes())
|
|
NewAttrs.push_back(AttributeWithIndex::get(~0, Attr));
|
|
|
|
// The trampoline may have been bitcast to a bogus type (FTy).
|
|
// Handle this by synthesizing a new function type, equal to FTy
|
|
// with the chain parameter inserted.
|
|
|
|
std::vector<const Type*> NewTypes;
|
|
NewTypes.reserve(FTy->getNumParams()+1);
|
|
|
|
// Insert the chain's type into the list of parameter types, which may
|
|
// mean appending it.
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned Idx = 1;
|
|
FunctionType::param_iterator I = FTy->param_begin(),
|
|
E = FTy->param_end();
|
|
|
|
do {
|
|
if (Idx == NestIdx)
|
|
// Add the chain's type.
|
|
NewTypes.push_back(NestTy);
|
|
|
|
if (I == E)
|
|
break;
|
|
|
|
// Add the original type.
|
|
NewTypes.push_back(*I);
|
|
|
|
++Idx, ++I;
|
|
} while (1);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Let the generic
|
|
// code sort out any function type mismatches.
|
|
FunctionType *NewFTy = FunctionType::get(FTy->getReturnType(), NewTypes,
|
|
FTy->isVarArg());
|
|
Constant *NewCallee =
|
|
NestF->getType() == PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy) ?
|
|
NestF : ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF,
|
|
PointerType::getUnqual(NewFTy));
|
|
const AttrListPtr &NewPAL = AttrListPtr::get(NewAttrs.begin(),
|
|
NewAttrs.end());
|
|
|
|
Instruction *NewCaller;
|
|
if (InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(Caller)) {
|
|
NewCaller = InvokeInst::Create(NewCallee,
|
|
II->getNormalDest(), II->getUnwindDest(),
|
|
NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
|
|
Caller->getName(), Caller);
|
|
cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setCallingConv(II->getCallingConv());
|
|
cast<InvokeInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
|
|
} else {
|
|
NewCaller = CallInst::Create(NewCallee, NewArgs.begin(), NewArgs.end(),
|
|
Caller->getName(), Caller);
|
|
if (cast<CallInst>(Caller)->isTailCall())
|
|
cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setTailCall();
|
|
cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->
|
|
setCallingConv(cast<CallInst>(Caller)->getCallingConv());
|
|
cast<CallInst>(NewCaller)->setAttributes(NewPAL);
|
|
}
|
|
if (!Caller->getType()->isVoidTy())
|
|
Caller->replaceAllUsesWith(NewCaller);
|
|
Caller->eraseFromParent();
|
|
Worklist.Remove(Caller);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Replace the trampoline call with a direct call. Since there is no 'nest'
|
|
// parameter, there is no need to adjust the argument list. Let the generic
|
|
// code sort out any function type mismatches.
|
|
Constant *NewCallee =
|
|
NestF->getType() == PTy ? NestF :
|
|
ConstantExpr::getBitCast(NestF, PTy);
|
|
CS.setCalledFunction(NewCallee);
|
|
return CS.getInstruction();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI - If we have something like phi [add (a,b), add(a,c)]
|
|
/// and if a/b/c and the add's all have a single use, turn this into a phi
|
|
/// and a single binop.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
|
|
Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
|
|
assert(isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst));
|
|
unsigned Opc = FirstInst->getOpcode();
|
|
Value *LHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *RHSVal = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
const Type *LHSType = LHSVal->getType();
|
|
const Type *RHSType = RHSVal->getType();
|
|
|
|
// Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
|
|
Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
if (!I || I->getOpcode() != Opc || !I->hasOneUse() ||
|
|
// Verify type of the LHS matches so we don't fold cmp's of different
|
|
// types or GEP's with different index types.
|
|
I->getOperand(0)->getType() != LHSType ||
|
|
I->getOperand(1)->getType() != RHSType)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// If they are CmpInst instructions, check their predicates
|
|
if (Opc == Instruction::ICmp || Opc == Instruction::FCmp)
|
|
if (cast<CmpInst>(I)->getPredicate() !=
|
|
cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst)->getPredicate())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Keep track of which operand needs a phi node.
|
|
if (I->getOperand(0) != LHSVal) LHSVal = 0;
|
|
if (I->getOperand(1) != RHSVal) RHSVal = 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If both LHS and RHS would need a PHI, don't do this transformation,
|
|
// because it would increase the number of PHIs entering the block,
|
|
// which leads to higher register pressure. This is especially
|
|
// bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
|
|
if (!LHSVal && !RHSVal)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, this is safe to transform!
|
|
|
|
Value *InLHS = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *InRHS = FirstInst->getOperand(1);
|
|
PHINode *NewLHS = 0, *NewRHS = 0;
|
|
if (LHSVal == 0) {
|
|
NewLHS = PHINode::Create(LHSType,
|
|
FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getName() + ".pn");
|
|
NewLHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
|
|
NewLHS->addIncoming(InLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewLHS, PN);
|
|
LHSVal = NewLHS;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (RHSVal == 0) {
|
|
NewRHS = PHINode::Create(RHSType,
|
|
FirstInst->getOperand(1)->getName() + ".pn");
|
|
NewRHS->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
|
|
NewRHS->addIncoming(InRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewRHS, PN);
|
|
RHSVal = NewRHS;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Add all operands to the new PHIs.
|
|
if (NewLHS || NewRHS) {
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
Instruction *InInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
if (NewLHS) {
|
|
Value *NewInLHS = InInst->getOperand(0);
|
|
NewLHS->addIncoming(NewInLHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
|
|
}
|
|
if (NewRHS) {
|
|
Value *NewInRHS = InInst->getOperand(1);
|
|
NewRHS->addIncoming(NewInRHS, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), LHSVal, RHSVal);
|
|
CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
|
|
return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
|
|
LHSVal, RHSVal);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
|
|
GetElementPtrInst *FirstInst =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
|
|
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 16> FixedOperands(FirstInst->op_begin(),
|
|
FirstInst->op_end());
|
|
// This is true if all GEP bases are allocas and if all indices into them are
|
|
// constants.
|
|
bool AllBasePointersAreAllocas = true;
|
|
|
|
// We don't want to replace this phi if the replacement would require
|
|
// more than one phi, which leads to higher register pressure. This is
|
|
// especially bad when the PHIs are in the header of a loop.
|
|
bool NeededPhi = false;
|
|
|
|
// Scan to see if all operands are the same opcode, and all have one use.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1; i != PN.getNumIncomingValues(); ++i) {
|
|
GetElementPtrInst *GEP= dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
if (!GEP || !GEP->hasOneUse() || GEP->getType() != FirstInst->getType() ||
|
|
GEP->getNumOperands() != FirstInst->getNumOperands())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Keep track of whether or not all GEPs are of alloca pointers.
|
|
if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas &&
|
|
(!isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)) ||
|
|
!GEP->hasAllConstantIndices()))
|
|
AllBasePointersAreAllocas = false;
|
|
|
|
// Compare the operand lists.
|
|
for (unsigned op = 0, e = FirstInst->getNumOperands(); op != e; ++op) {
|
|
if (FirstInst->getOperand(op) == GEP->getOperand(op))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
// Don't merge two GEPs when two operands differ (introducing phi nodes)
|
|
// if one of the PHIs has a constant for the index. The index may be
|
|
// substantially cheaper to compute for the constants, so making it a
|
|
// variable index could pessimize the path. This also handles the case
|
|
// for struct indices, which must always be constant.
|
|
if (isa<ConstantInt>(FirstInst->getOperand(op)) ||
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(GEP->getOperand(op)))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (FirstInst->getOperand(op)->getType() !=GEP->getOperand(op)->getType())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// If we already needed a PHI for an earlier operand, and another operand
|
|
// also requires a PHI, we'd be introducing more PHIs than we're
|
|
// eliminating, which increases register pressure on entry to the PHI's
|
|
// block.
|
|
if (NeededPhi)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
FixedOperands[op] = 0; // Needs a PHI.
|
|
NeededPhi = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If all of the base pointers of the PHI'd GEPs are from allocas, don't
|
|
// bother doing this transformation. At best, this will just save a bit of
|
|
// offset calculation, but all the predecessors will have to materialize the
|
|
// stack address into a register anyway. We'd actually rather *clone* the
|
|
// load up into the predecessors so that we have a load of a gep of an alloca,
|
|
// which can usually all be folded into the load.
|
|
if (AllBasePointersAreAllocas)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, this is safe to transform. Insert PHI nodes for each operand
|
|
// that is variable.
|
|
SmallVector<PHINode*, 16> OperandPhis(FixedOperands.size());
|
|
|
|
bool HasAnyPHIs = false;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = FixedOperands.size(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
if (FixedOperands[i]) continue; // operand doesn't need a phi.
|
|
Value *FirstOp = FirstInst->getOperand(i);
|
|
PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstOp->getType(),
|
|
FirstOp->getName()+".pn");
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
|
|
|
|
NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(e);
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(FirstOp, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
|
|
OperandPhis[i] = NewPN;
|
|
FixedOperands[i] = NewPN;
|
|
HasAnyPHIs = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
// Add all operands to the new PHIs.
|
|
if (HasAnyPHIs) {
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
GetElementPtrInst *InGEP =cast<GetElementPtrInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
BasicBlock *InBB = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned op = 0, e = OperandPhis.size(); op != e; ++op)
|
|
if (PHINode *OpPhi = OperandPhis[op])
|
|
OpPhi->addIncoming(InGEP->getOperand(op), InBB);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *Base = FixedOperands[0];
|
|
return cast<GEPOperator>(FirstInst)->isInBounds() ?
|
|
GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
|
|
FixedOperands.end()) :
|
|
GetElementPtrInst::Create(Base, FixedOperands.begin()+1,
|
|
FixedOperands.end());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad - Return true if we know that it is safe to
|
|
/// sink the load out of the block that defines it. This means that it must be
|
|
/// obvious the value of the load is not changed from the point of the load to
|
|
/// the end of the block it is in.
|
|
///
|
|
/// Finally, it is safe, but not profitable, to sink a load targetting a
|
|
/// non-address-taken alloca. Doing so will cause us to not promote the alloca
|
|
/// to a register.
|
|
static bool isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LoadInst *L) {
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BBI = L, E = L->getParent()->end();
|
|
|
|
for (++BBI; BBI != E; ++BBI)
|
|
if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory())
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Check for non-address taken alloca. If not address-taken already, it isn't
|
|
// profitable to do this xform.
|
|
if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(L->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
bool isAddressTaken = false;
|
|
for (Value::use_iterator UI = AI->use_begin(), E = AI->use_end();
|
|
UI != E; ++UI) {
|
|
if (isa<LoadInst>(UI)) continue;
|
|
if (StoreInst *SI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(*UI)) {
|
|
// If storing TO the alloca, then the address isn't taken.
|
|
if (SI->getOperand(1) == AI) continue;
|
|
}
|
|
isAddressTaken = true;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!isAddressTaken && AI->isStaticAlloca())
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this load is a load from a GEP with a constant offset from an alloca,
|
|
// then we don't want to sink it. In its present form, it will be
|
|
// load [constant stack offset]. Sinking it will cause us to have to
|
|
// materialize the stack addresses in each predecessor in a register only to
|
|
// do a shared load from register in the successor.
|
|
if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(L->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (AllocaInst *AI = dyn_cast<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (AI->isStaticAlloca() && GEP->hasAllConstantIndices())
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgLoadIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
|
|
LoadInst *FirstLI = cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
|
|
|
|
// When processing loads, we need to propagate two bits of information to the
|
|
// sunk load: whether it is volatile, and what its alignment is. We currently
|
|
// don't sink loads when some have their alignment specified and some don't.
|
|
// visitLoadInst will propagate an alignment onto the load when TD is around,
|
|
// and if TD isn't around, we can't handle the mixed case.
|
|
bool isVolatile = FirstLI->isVolatile();
|
|
unsigned LoadAlignment = FirstLI->getAlignment();
|
|
|
|
// We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between the
|
|
// load and the PHI.
|
|
if (FirstLI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(0) ||
|
|
!isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(FirstLI))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
|
|
// successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
|
|
// the path through the other successor.
|
|
if (isVolatile &&
|
|
FirstLI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
if (!LI || !LI->hasOneUse())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// We can't sink the load if the loaded value could be modified between
|
|
// the load and the PHI.
|
|
if (LI->isVolatile() != isVolatile ||
|
|
LI->getParent() != PN.getIncomingBlock(i) ||
|
|
!isSafeAndProfitableToSinkLoad(LI))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// If some of the loads have an alignment specified but not all of them,
|
|
// we can't do the transformation.
|
|
if ((LoadAlignment != 0) != (LI->getAlignment() != 0))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
LoadAlignment = std::min(LoadAlignment, LI->getAlignment());
|
|
|
|
// If the PHI is of volatile loads and the load block has multiple
|
|
// successors, sinking it would remove a load of the volatile value from
|
|
// the path through the other successor.
|
|
if (isVolatile &&
|
|
LI->getParent()->getTerminator()->getNumSuccessors() != 1)
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
|
|
// correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
|
|
PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstLI->getOperand(0)->getType(),
|
|
PN.getName()+".in");
|
|
NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
|
|
|
|
Value *InVal = FirstLI->getOperand(0);
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
|
|
|
|
// Add all operands to the new PHI.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
Value *NewInVal = cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
|
|
if (NewInVal != InVal)
|
|
InVal = 0;
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *PhiVal;
|
|
if (InVal) {
|
|
// The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
|
|
// common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
|
|
PhiVal = InVal;
|
|
delete NewPN;
|
|
} else {
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
|
|
PhiVal = NewPN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this was a volatile load that we are merging, make sure to loop through
|
|
// and mark all the input loads as non-volatile. If we don't do this, we will
|
|
// insert a new volatile load and the old ones will not be deletable.
|
|
if (isVolatile)
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
cast<LoadInst>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->setVolatile(false);
|
|
|
|
return new LoadInst(PhiVal, "", isVolatile, LoadAlignment);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI - If all operands to a PHI node are the same "unary"
|
|
/// operator and they all are only used by the PHI, PHI together their
|
|
/// inputs, and do the operation once, to the result of the PHI.
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PHINode &PN) {
|
|
Instruction *FirstInst = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0));
|
|
|
|
if (isa<GetElementPtrInst>(FirstInst))
|
|
return FoldPHIArgGEPIntoPHI(PN);
|
|
if (isa<LoadInst>(FirstInst))
|
|
return FoldPHIArgLoadIntoPHI(PN);
|
|
|
|
// Scan the instruction, looking for input operations that can be folded away.
|
|
// If all input operands to the phi are the same instruction (e.g. a cast from
|
|
// the same type or "+42") we can pull the operation through the PHI, reducing
|
|
// code size and simplifying code.
|
|
Constant *ConstantOp = 0;
|
|
const Type *CastSrcTy = 0;
|
|
|
|
if (isa<CastInst>(FirstInst)) {
|
|
CastSrcTy = FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType();
|
|
|
|
// Be careful about transforming integer PHIs. We don't want to pessimize
|
|
// the code by turning an i32 into an i1293.
|
|
if (isa<IntegerType>(PN.getType()) && isa<IntegerType>(CastSrcTy)) {
|
|
if (!ShouldChangeType(PN.getType(), CastSrcTy))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (isa<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst) || isa<CmpInst>(FirstInst)) {
|
|
// Can fold binop, compare or shift here if the RHS is a constant,
|
|
// otherwise call FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI.
|
|
ConstantOp = dyn_cast<Constant>(FirstInst->getOperand(1));
|
|
if (ConstantOp == 0)
|
|
return FoldPHIArgBinOpIntoPHI(PN);
|
|
} else {
|
|
return 0; // Cannot fold this operation.
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if all arguments are the same operation.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
if (I == 0 || !I->hasOneUse() || !I->isSameOperationAs(FirstInst))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
if (CastSrcTy) {
|
|
if (I->getOperand(0)->getType() != CastSrcTy)
|
|
return 0; // Cast operation must match.
|
|
} else if (I->getOperand(1) != ConstantOp) {
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Okay, they are all the same operation. Create a new PHI node of the
|
|
// correct type, and PHI together all of the LHS's of the instructions.
|
|
PHINode *NewPN = PHINode::Create(FirstInst->getOperand(0)->getType(),
|
|
PN.getName()+".in");
|
|
NewPN->reserveOperandSpace(PN.getNumOperands()/2);
|
|
|
|
Value *InVal = FirstInst->getOperand(0);
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(InVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(0));
|
|
|
|
// Add all operands to the new PHI.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PN.getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
Value *NewInVal = cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(i))->getOperand(0);
|
|
if (NewInVal != InVal)
|
|
InVal = 0;
|
|
NewPN->addIncoming(NewInVal, PN.getIncomingBlock(i));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Value *PhiVal;
|
|
if (InVal) {
|
|
// The new PHI unions all of the same values together. This is really
|
|
// common, so we handle it intelligently here for compile-time speed.
|
|
PhiVal = InVal;
|
|
delete NewPN;
|
|
} else {
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(NewPN, PN);
|
|
PhiVal = NewPN;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Insert and return the new operation.
|
|
if (CastInst *FirstCI = dyn_cast<CastInst>(FirstInst))
|
|
return CastInst::Create(FirstCI->getOpcode(), PhiVal, PN.getType());
|
|
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BinOp = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(FirstInst))
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BinOp->getOpcode(), PhiVal, ConstantOp);
|
|
|
|
CmpInst *CIOp = cast<CmpInst>(FirstInst);
|
|
return CmpInst::Create(CIOp->getOpcode(), CIOp->getPredicate(),
|
|
PhiVal, ConstantOp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// DeadPHICycle - Return true if this PHI node is only used by a PHI node cycle
|
|
/// that is dead.
|
|
static bool DeadPHICycle(PHINode *PN,
|
|
SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &PotentiallyDeadPHIs) {
|
|
if (PN->use_empty()) return true;
|
|
if (!PN->hasOneUse()) return false;
|
|
|
|
// Remember this node, and if we find the cycle, return.
|
|
if (!PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(PN))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Don't scan crazily complex things.
|
|
if (PotentiallyDeadPHIs.size() == 16)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->use_back()))
|
|
return DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs);
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// PHIsEqualValue - Return true if this phi node is always equal to
|
|
/// NonPhiInVal. This happens with mutually cyclic phi nodes like:
|
|
/// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
|
|
static bool PHIsEqualValue(PHINode *PN, Value *NonPhiInVal,
|
|
SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> &ValueEqualPHIs) {
|
|
// See if we already saw this PHI node.
|
|
if (!ValueEqualPHIs.insert(PN))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Don't scan crazily complex things.
|
|
if (ValueEqualPHIs.size() == 16)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Scan the operands to see if they are either phi nodes or are equal to
|
|
// the value.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
Value *Op = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
|
|
if (PHINode *OpPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(Op)) {
|
|
if (!PHIsEqualValue(OpPN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
|
|
return false;
|
|
} else if (Op != NonPhiInVal)
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
namespace {
|
|
struct PHIUsageRecord {
|
|
unsigned PHIId; // The ID # of the PHI (something determinstic to sort on)
|
|
unsigned Shift; // The amount shifted.
|
|
Instruction *Inst; // The trunc instruction.
|
|
|
|
PHIUsageRecord(unsigned pn, unsigned Sh, Instruction *User)
|
|
: PHIId(pn), Shift(Sh), Inst(User) {}
|
|
|
|
bool operator<(const PHIUsageRecord &RHS) const {
|
|
if (PHIId < RHS.PHIId) return true;
|
|
if (PHIId > RHS.PHIId) return false;
|
|
if (Shift < RHS.Shift) return true;
|
|
if (Shift > RHS.Shift) return false;
|
|
return Inst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits() <
|
|
RHS.Inst->getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits();
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
|
|
struct LoweredPHIRecord {
|
|
PHINode *PN; // The PHI that was lowered.
|
|
unsigned Shift; // The amount shifted.
|
|
unsigned Width; // The width extracted.
|
|
|
|
LoweredPHIRecord(PHINode *pn, unsigned Sh, const Type *Ty)
|
|
: PN(pn), Shift(Sh), Width(Ty->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()) {}
|
|
|
|
// Ctor form used by DenseMap.
|
|
LoweredPHIRecord(PHINode *pn, unsigned Sh)
|
|
: PN(pn), Shift(Sh), Width(0) {}
|
|
};
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
namespace llvm {
|
|
template<>
|
|
struct DenseMapInfo<LoweredPHIRecord> {
|
|
static inline LoweredPHIRecord getEmptyKey() {
|
|
return LoweredPHIRecord(0, 0);
|
|
}
|
|
static inline LoweredPHIRecord getTombstoneKey() {
|
|
return LoweredPHIRecord(0, 1);
|
|
}
|
|
static unsigned getHashValue(const LoweredPHIRecord &Val) {
|
|
return DenseMapInfo<PHINode*>::getHashValue(Val.PN) ^ (Val.Shift>>3) ^
|
|
(Val.Width>>3);
|
|
}
|
|
static bool isEqual(const LoweredPHIRecord &LHS,
|
|
const LoweredPHIRecord &RHS) {
|
|
return LHS.PN == RHS.PN && LHS.Shift == RHS.Shift &&
|
|
LHS.Width == RHS.Width;
|
|
}
|
|
};
|
|
template <>
|
|
struct isPodLike<LoweredPHIRecord> { static const bool value = true; };
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI - This is an integer PHI and we know that it has an
|
|
/// illegal type: see if it is only used by trunc or trunc(lshr) operations. If
|
|
/// so, we split the PHI into the various pieces being extracted. This sort of
|
|
/// thing is introduced when SROA promotes an aggregate to large integer values.
|
|
///
|
|
/// TODO: The user of the trunc may be an bitcast to float/double/vector or an
|
|
/// inttoptr. We should produce new PHIs in the right type.
|
|
///
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI(PHINode &FirstPhi) {
|
|
// PHIUsers - Keep track of all of the truncated values extracted from a set
|
|
// of PHIs, along with their offset. These are the things we want to rewrite.
|
|
SmallVector<PHIUsageRecord, 16> PHIUsers;
|
|
|
|
// PHIs are often mutually cyclic, so we keep track of a whole set of PHI
|
|
// nodes which are extracted from. PHIsToSlice is a set we use to avoid
|
|
// revisiting PHIs, PHIsInspected is a ordered list of PHIs that we need to
|
|
// check the uses of (to ensure they are all extracts).
|
|
SmallVector<PHINode*, 8> PHIsToSlice;
|
|
SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 8> PHIsInspected;
|
|
|
|
PHIsToSlice.push_back(&FirstPhi);
|
|
PHIsInspected.insert(&FirstPhi);
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned PHIId = 0; PHIId != PHIsToSlice.size(); ++PHIId) {
|
|
PHINode *PN = PHIsToSlice[PHIId];
|
|
|
|
// Scan the input list of the PHI. If any input is an invoke, and if the
|
|
// input is defined in the predecessor, then we won't be split the critical
|
|
// edge which is required to insert a truncate. Because of this, we have to
|
|
// bail out.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
InvokeInst *II = dyn_cast<InvokeInst>(PN->getIncomingValue(i));
|
|
if (II == 0) continue;
|
|
if (II->getParent() != PN->getIncomingBlock(i))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
// If we have a phi, and if it's directly in the predecessor, then we have
|
|
// a critical edge where we need to put the truncate. Since we can't
|
|
// split the edge in instcombine, we have to bail out.
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
for (Value::use_iterator UI = PN->use_begin(), E = PN->use_end();
|
|
UI != E; ++UI) {
|
|
Instruction *User = cast<Instruction>(*UI);
|
|
|
|
// If the user is a PHI, inspect its uses recursively.
|
|
if (PHINode *UserPN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(User)) {
|
|
if (PHIsInspected.insert(UserPN))
|
|
PHIsToSlice.push_back(UserPN);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Truncates are always ok.
|
|
if (isa<TruncInst>(User)) {
|
|
PHIUsers.push_back(PHIUsageRecord(PHIId, 0, User));
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise it must be a lshr which can only be used by one trunc.
|
|
if (User->getOpcode() != Instruction::LShr ||
|
|
!User->hasOneUse() || !isa<TruncInst>(User->use_back()) ||
|
|
!isa<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1)))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
unsigned Shift = cast<ConstantInt>(User->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
|
|
PHIUsers.push_back(PHIUsageRecord(PHIId, Shift, User->use_back()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we have no users, they must be all self uses, just nuke the PHI.
|
|
if (PHIUsers.empty())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FirstPhi, UndefValue::get(FirstPhi.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// If this phi node is transformable, create new PHIs for all the pieces
|
|
// extracted out of it. First, sort the users by their offset and size.
|
|
array_pod_sort(PHIUsers.begin(), PHIUsers.end());
|
|
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "SLICING UP PHI: " << FirstPhi << '\n';
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PHIsToSlice.size(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
errs() << "AND USER PHI #" << i << ": " << *PHIsToSlice[i] <<'\n';
|
|
);
|
|
|
|
// PredValues - This is a temporary used when rewriting PHI nodes. It is
|
|
// hoisted out here to avoid construction/destruction thrashing.
|
|
DenseMap<BasicBlock*, Value*> PredValues;
|
|
|
|
// ExtractedVals - Each new PHI we introduce is saved here so we don't
|
|
// introduce redundant PHIs.
|
|
DenseMap<LoweredPHIRecord, PHINode*> ExtractedVals;
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned UserI = 0, UserE = PHIUsers.size(); UserI != UserE; ++UserI) {
|
|
unsigned PHIId = PHIUsers[UserI].PHIId;
|
|
PHINode *PN = PHIsToSlice[PHIId];
|
|
unsigned Offset = PHIUsers[UserI].Shift;
|
|
const Type *Ty = PHIUsers[UserI].Inst->getType();
|
|
|
|
PHINode *EltPHI;
|
|
|
|
// If we've already lowered a user like this, reuse the previously lowered
|
|
// value.
|
|
if ((EltPHI = ExtractedVals[LoweredPHIRecord(PN, Offset, Ty)]) == 0) {
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, Create the new PHI node for this user.
|
|
EltPHI = PHINode::Create(Ty, PN->getName()+".off"+Twine(Offset), PN);
|
|
assert(EltPHI->getType() != PN->getType() &&
|
|
"Truncate didn't shrink phi?");
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = PN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
BasicBlock *Pred = PN->getIncomingBlock(i);
|
|
Value *&PredVal = PredValues[Pred];
|
|
|
|
// If we already have a value for this predecessor, reuse it.
|
|
if (PredVal) {
|
|
EltPHI->addIncoming(PredVal, Pred);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Handle the PHI self-reuse case.
|
|
Value *InVal = PN->getIncomingValue(i);
|
|
if (InVal == PN) {
|
|
PredVal = EltPHI;
|
|
EltPHI->addIncoming(PredVal, Pred);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (PHINode *InPHI = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN)) {
|
|
// If the incoming value was a PHI, and if it was one of the PHIs we
|
|
// already rewrote it, just use the lowered value.
|
|
if (Value *Res = ExtractedVals[LoweredPHIRecord(InPHI, Offset, Ty)]) {
|
|
PredVal = Res;
|
|
EltPHI->addIncoming(PredVal, Pred);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, do an extract in the predecessor.
|
|
Builder->SetInsertPoint(Pred, Pred->getTerminator());
|
|
Value *Res = InVal;
|
|
if (Offset)
|
|
Res = Builder->CreateLShr(Res, ConstantInt::get(InVal->getType(),
|
|
Offset), "extract");
|
|
Res = Builder->CreateTrunc(Res, Ty, "extract.t");
|
|
PredVal = Res;
|
|
EltPHI->addIncoming(Res, Pred);
|
|
|
|
// If the incoming value was a PHI, and if it was one of the PHIs we are
|
|
// rewriting, we will ultimately delete the code we inserted. This
|
|
// means we need to revisit that PHI to make sure we extract out the
|
|
// needed piece.
|
|
if (PHINode *OldInVal = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PN->getIncomingValue(i)))
|
|
if (PHIsInspected.count(OldInVal)) {
|
|
unsigned RefPHIId = std::find(PHIsToSlice.begin(),PHIsToSlice.end(),
|
|
OldInVal)-PHIsToSlice.begin();
|
|
PHIUsers.push_back(PHIUsageRecord(RefPHIId, Offset,
|
|
cast<Instruction>(Res)));
|
|
++UserE;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
PredValues.clear();
|
|
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << " Made element PHI for offset " << Offset << ": "
|
|
<< *EltPHI << '\n');
|
|
ExtractedVals[LoweredPHIRecord(PN, Offset, Ty)] = EltPHI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Replace the use of this piece with the PHI node.
|
|
ReplaceInstUsesWith(*PHIUsers[UserI].Inst, EltPHI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Replace all the remaining uses of the PHI nodes (self uses and the lshrs)
|
|
// with undefs.
|
|
Value *Undef = UndefValue::get(FirstPhi.getType());
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = PHIsToSlice.size(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
ReplaceInstUsesWith(*PHIsToSlice[i], Undef);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(FirstPhi, Undef);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// PHINode simplification
|
|
//
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitPHINode(PHINode &PN) {
|
|
// If LCSSA is around, don't mess with Phi nodes
|
|
if (MustPreserveLCSSA) return 0;
|
|
|
|
if (Value *V = PN.hasConstantValue())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, V);
|
|
|
|
// If all PHI operands are the same operation, pull them through the PHI,
|
|
// reducing code size.
|
|
if (isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0)) &&
|
|
isa<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1)) &&
|
|
cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(0))->getOpcode() ==
|
|
cast<Instruction>(PN.getIncomingValue(1))->getOpcode() &&
|
|
// FIXME: The hasOneUse check will fail for PHIs that use the value more
|
|
// than themselves more than once.
|
|
PN.getIncomingValue(0)->hasOneUse())
|
|
if (Instruction *Result = FoldPHIArgOpIntoPHI(PN))
|
|
return Result;
|
|
|
|
// If this is a trivial cycle in the PHI node graph, remove it. Basically, if
|
|
// this PHI only has a single use (a PHI), and if that PHI only has one use (a
|
|
// PHI)... break the cycle.
|
|
if (PN.hasOneUse()) {
|
|
Instruction *PHIUser = cast<Instruction>(PN.use_back());
|
|
if (PHINode *PU = dyn_cast<PHINode>(PHIUser)) {
|
|
SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> PotentiallyDeadPHIs;
|
|
PotentiallyDeadPHIs.insert(&PN);
|
|
if (DeadPHICycle(PU, PotentiallyDeadPHIs))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this phi has a single use, and if that use just computes a value for
|
|
// the next iteration of a loop, delete the phi. This occurs with unused
|
|
// induction variables, e.g. "for (int j = 0; ; ++j);". Detecting this
|
|
// common case here is good because the only other things that catch this
|
|
// are induction variable analysis (sometimes) and ADCE, which is only run
|
|
// late.
|
|
if (PHIUser->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
(isa<BinaryOperator>(PHIUser) || isa<GetElementPtrInst>(PHIUser)) &&
|
|
PHIUser->use_back() == &PN) {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, UndefValue::get(PN.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// We sometimes end up with phi cycles that non-obviously end up being the
|
|
// same value, for example:
|
|
// z = some value; x = phi (y, z); y = phi (x, z)
|
|
// where the phi nodes don't necessarily need to be in the same block. Do a
|
|
// quick check to see if the PHI node only contains a single non-phi value, if
|
|
// so, scan to see if the phi cycle is actually equal to that value.
|
|
{
|
|
unsigned InValNo = 0, NumOperandVals = PN.getNumIncomingValues();
|
|
// Scan for the first non-phi operand.
|
|
while (InValNo != NumOperandVals &&
|
|
isa<PHINode>(PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo)))
|
|
++InValNo;
|
|
|
|
if (InValNo != NumOperandVals) {
|
|
Value *NonPhiInVal = PN.getOperand(InValNo);
|
|
|
|
// Scan the rest of the operands to see if there are any conflicts, if so
|
|
// there is no need to recursively scan other phis.
|
|
for (++InValNo; InValNo != NumOperandVals; ++InValNo) {
|
|
Value *OpVal = PN.getIncomingValue(InValNo);
|
|
if (OpVal != NonPhiInVal && !isa<PHINode>(OpVal))
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we scanned over all operands, then we have one unique value plus
|
|
// phi values. Scan PHI nodes to see if they all merge in each other or
|
|
// the value.
|
|
if (InValNo == NumOperandVals) {
|
|
SmallPtrSet<PHINode*, 16> ValueEqualPHIs;
|
|
if (PHIsEqualValue(&PN, NonPhiInVal, ValueEqualPHIs))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(PN, NonPhiInVal);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If there are multiple PHIs, sort their operands so that they all list
|
|
// the blocks in the same order. This will help identical PHIs be eliminated
|
|
// by other passes. Other passes shouldn't depend on this for correctness
|
|
// however.
|
|
PHINode *FirstPN = cast<PHINode>(PN.getParent()->begin());
|
|
if (&PN != FirstPN)
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = FirstPN->getNumIncomingValues(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
BasicBlock *BBA = PN.getIncomingBlock(i);
|
|
BasicBlock *BBB = FirstPN->getIncomingBlock(i);
|
|
if (BBA != BBB) {
|
|
Value *VA = PN.getIncomingValue(i);
|
|
unsigned j = PN.getBasicBlockIndex(BBB);
|
|
Value *VB = PN.getIncomingValue(j);
|
|
PN.setIncomingBlock(i, BBB);
|
|
PN.setIncomingValue(i, VB);
|
|
PN.setIncomingBlock(j, BBA);
|
|
PN.setIncomingValue(j, VA);
|
|
// NOTE: Instcombine normally would want us to "return &PN" if we
|
|
// modified any of the operands of an instruction. However, since we
|
|
// aren't adding or removing uses (just rearranging them) we don't do
|
|
// this in this case.
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this is an integer PHI and we know that it has an illegal type, see if
|
|
// it is only used by trunc or trunc(lshr) operations. If so, we split the
|
|
// PHI into the various pieces being extracted. This sort of thing is
|
|
// introduced when SROA promotes an aggregate to a single large integer type.
|
|
if (isa<IntegerType>(PN.getType()) && TD &&
|
|
!TD->isLegalInteger(PN.getType()->getPrimitiveSizeInBits()))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = SliceUpIllegalIntegerPHI(PN))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitGetElementPtrInst(GetElementPtrInst &GEP) {
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 8> Ops(GEP.op_begin(), GEP.op_end());
|
|
|
|
if (Value *V = SimplifyGEPInst(&Ops[0], Ops.size(), TD))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, V);
|
|
|
|
Value *PtrOp = GEP.getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(GEP.getOperand(0)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, UndefValue::get(GEP.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// Eliminate unneeded casts for indices.
|
|
if (TD) {
|
|
bool MadeChange = false;
|
|
unsigned PtrSize = TD->getPointerSizeInBits();
|
|
|
|
gep_type_iterator GTI = gep_type_begin(GEP);
|
|
for (User::op_iterator I = GEP.op_begin() + 1, E = GEP.op_end();
|
|
I != E; ++I, ++GTI) {
|
|
if (!isa<SequentialType>(*GTI)) continue;
|
|
|
|
// If we are using a wider index than needed for this platform, shrink it
|
|
// to what we need. If narrower, sign-extend it to what we need. This
|
|
// explicit cast can make subsequent optimizations more obvious.
|
|
unsigned OpBits = cast<IntegerType>((*I)->getType())->getBitWidth();
|
|
if (OpBits == PtrSize)
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
*I = Builder->CreateIntCast(*I, TD->getIntPtrType(GEP.getContext()),true);
|
|
MadeChange = true;
|
|
}
|
|
if (MadeChange) return &GEP;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Combine Indices - If the source pointer to this getelementptr instruction
|
|
// is a getelementptr instruction, combine the indices of the two
|
|
// getelementptr instructions into a single instruction.
|
|
//
|
|
if (GEPOperator *Src = dyn_cast<GEPOperator>(PtrOp)) {
|
|
// Note that if our source is a gep chain itself that we wait for that
|
|
// chain to be resolved before we perform this transformation. This
|
|
// avoids us creating a TON of code in some cases.
|
|
//
|
|
if (GetElementPtrInst *SrcGEP =
|
|
dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Src->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (SrcGEP->getNumOperands() == 2)
|
|
return 0; // Wait until our source is folded to completion.
|
|
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices;
|
|
|
|
// Find out whether the last index in the source GEP is a sequential idx.
|
|
bool EndsWithSequential = false;
|
|
for (gep_type_iterator I = gep_type_begin(*Src), E = gep_type_end(*Src);
|
|
I != E; ++I)
|
|
EndsWithSequential = !isa<StructType>(*I);
|
|
|
|
// Can we combine the two pointer arithmetics offsets?
|
|
if (EndsWithSequential) {
|
|
// Replace: gep (gep %P, long B), long A, ...
|
|
// With: T = long A+B; gep %P, T, ...
|
|
//
|
|
Value *Sum;
|
|
Value *SO1 = Src->getOperand(Src->getNumOperands()-1);
|
|
Value *GO1 = GEP.getOperand(1);
|
|
if (SO1 == Constant::getNullValue(SO1->getType())) {
|
|
Sum = GO1;
|
|
} else if (GO1 == Constant::getNullValue(GO1->getType())) {
|
|
Sum = SO1;
|
|
} else {
|
|
// If they aren't the same type, then the input hasn't been processed
|
|
// by the loop above yet (which canonicalizes sequential index types to
|
|
// intptr_t). Just avoid transforming this until the input has been
|
|
// normalized.
|
|
if (SO1->getType() != GO1->getType())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
Sum = Builder->CreateAdd(SO1, GO1, PtrOp->getName()+".sum");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Update the GEP in place if possible.
|
|
if (Src->getNumOperands() == 2) {
|
|
GEP.setOperand(0, Src->getOperand(0));
|
|
GEP.setOperand(1, Sum);
|
|
return &GEP;
|
|
}
|
|
Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end()-1);
|
|
Indices.push_back(Sum);
|
|
Indices.append(GEP.op_begin()+2, GEP.op_end());
|
|
} else if (isa<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin()) &&
|
|
cast<Constant>(*GEP.idx_begin())->isNullValue() &&
|
|
Src->getNumOperands() != 1) {
|
|
// Otherwise we can do the fold if the first index of the GEP is a zero
|
|
Indices.append(Src->op_begin()+1, Src->op_end());
|
|
Indices.append(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!Indices.empty())
|
|
return (cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() &&
|
|
Src->isInBounds()) ?
|
|
GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
|
|
Indices.end(), GEP.getName()) :
|
|
GetElementPtrInst::Create(Src->getOperand(0), Indices.begin(),
|
|
Indices.end(), GEP.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Handle gep(bitcast x) and gep(gep x, 0, 0, 0).
|
|
if (Value *X = getBitCastOperand(PtrOp)) {
|
|
assert(isa<PointerType>(X->getType()) && "Must be cast from pointer");
|
|
|
|
// If the input bitcast is actually "bitcast(bitcast(x))", then we don't
|
|
// want to change the gep until the bitcasts are eliminated.
|
|
if (getBitCastOperand(X)) {
|
|
Worklist.AddValue(PtrOp);
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool HasZeroPointerIndex = false;
|
|
if (ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1)))
|
|
HasZeroPointerIndex = C->isZero();
|
|
|
|
// Transform: GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
|
|
// into : GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
|
|
//
|
|
// Likewise, transform: GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ...
|
|
// into : GEP i8* X, ...
|
|
//
|
|
// This occurs when the program declares an array extern like "int X[];"
|
|
if (HasZeroPointerIndex) {
|
|
const PointerType *CPTy = cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType());
|
|
const PointerType *XTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType());
|
|
if (const ArrayType *CATy =
|
|
dyn_cast<ArrayType>(CPTy->getElementType())) {
|
|
// GEP (bitcast i8* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
|
|
if (CATy->getElementType() == XTy->getElementType()) {
|
|
// -> GEP i8* X, ...
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 8> Indices(GEP.idx_begin()+1, GEP.idx_end());
|
|
return cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
|
|
GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
|
|
GEP.getName()) :
|
|
GetElementPtrInst::Create(X, Indices.begin(), Indices.end(),
|
|
GEP.getName());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (const ArrayType *XATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(XTy->getElementType())){
|
|
// GEP (bitcast [10 x i8]* X to [0 x i8]*), i32 0, ... ?
|
|
if (CATy->getElementType() == XATy->getElementType()) {
|
|
// -> GEP [10 x i8]* X, i32 0, ...
|
|
// At this point, we know that the cast source type is a pointer
|
|
// to an array of the same type as the destination pointer
|
|
// array. Because the array type is never stepped over (there
|
|
// is a leading zero) we can fold the cast into this GEP.
|
|
GEP.setOperand(0, X);
|
|
return &GEP;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (GEP.getNumOperands() == 2) {
|
|
// Transform things like:
|
|
// %t = getelementptr i32* bitcast ([2 x i32]* %str to i32*), i32 %V
|
|
// into: %t1 = getelementptr [2 x i32]* %str, i32 0, i32 %V; bitcast
|
|
const Type *SrcElTy = cast<PointerType>(X->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
const Type *ResElTy=cast<PointerType>(PtrOp->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
|
|
TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType()) ==
|
|
TD->getTypeAllocSize(ResElTy)) {
|
|
Value *Idx[2];
|
|
Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(GEP.getContext()));
|
|
Idx[1] = GEP.getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
|
|
Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
|
|
Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
|
|
// V and GEP are both pointer types --> BitCast
|
|
return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Transform things like:
|
|
// getelementptr i8* bitcast ([100 x double]* X to i8*), i32 %tmp
|
|
// (where tmp = 8*tmp2) into:
|
|
// getelementptr [100 x double]* %arr, i32 0, i32 %tmp2; bitcast
|
|
|
|
if (TD && isa<ArrayType>(SrcElTy) &&
|
|
ResElTy == Type::getInt8Ty(GEP.getContext())) {
|
|
uint64_t ArrayEltSize =
|
|
TD->getTypeAllocSize(cast<ArrayType>(SrcElTy)->getElementType());
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if "tmp" is a scale by a multiple of ArrayEltSize. We
|
|
// allow either a mul, shift, or constant here.
|
|
Value *NewIdx = 0;
|
|
ConstantInt *Scale = 0;
|
|
if (ArrayEltSize == 1) {
|
|
NewIdx = GEP.getOperand(1);
|
|
Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(NewIdx->getType()), 1);
|
|
} else if (ConstantInt *CI = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(GEP.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
NewIdx = ConstantInt::get(CI->getType(), 1);
|
|
Scale = CI;
|
|
} else if (Instruction *Inst =dyn_cast<Instruction>(GEP.getOperand(1))){
|
|
if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Shl &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
ConstantInt *ShAmt = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
|
|
uint32_t ShAmtVal = ShAmt->getLimitedValue(64);
|
|
Scale = ConstantInt::get(cast<IntegerType>(Inst->getType()),
|
|
1ULL << ShAmtVal);
|
|
NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
|
|
} else if (Inst->getOpcode() == Instruction::Mul &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
Scale = cast<ConstantInt>(Inst->getOperand(1));
|
|
NewIdx = Inst->getOperand(0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the index will be to exactly the right offset with the scale taken
|
|
// out, perform the transformation. Note, we don't know whether Scale is
|
|
// signed or not. We'll use unsigned version of division/modulo
|
|
// operation after making sure Scale doesn't have the sign bit set.
|
|
if (ArrayEltSize && Scale && Scale->getSExtValue() >= 0LL &&
|
|
Scale->getZExtValue() % ArrayEltSize == 0) {
|
|
Scale = ConstantInt::get(Scale->getType(),
|
|
Scale->getZExtValue() / ArrayEltSize);
|
|
if (Scale->getZExtValue() != 1) {
|
|
Constant *C = ConstantExpr::getIntegerCast(Scale, NewIdx->getType(),
|
|
false /*ZExt*/);
|
|
NewIdx = Builder->CreateMul(NewIdx, C, "idxscale");
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Insert the new GEP instruction.
|
|
Value *Idx[2];
|
|
Idx[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(GEP.getContext()));
|
|
Idx[1] = NewIdx;
|
|
Value *NewGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
|
|
Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName()) :
|
|
Builder->CreateGEP(X, Idx, Idx + 2, GEP.getName());
|
|
// The NewGEP must be pointer typed, so must the old one -> BitCast
|
|
return new BitCastInst(NewGEP, GEP.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// See if we can simplify:
|
|
/// X = bitcast A* to B*
|
|
/// Y = gep X, <...constant indices...>
|
|
/// into a gep of the original struct. This is important for SROA and alias
|
|
/// analysis of unions. If "A" is also a bitcast, wait for A/X to be merged.
|
|
if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(PtrOp)) {
|
|
if (TD &&
|
|
!isa<BitCastInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) && GEP.hasAllConstantIndices()) {
|
|
// Determine how much the GEP moves the pointer. We are guaranteed to get
|
|
// a constant back from EmitGEPOffset.
|
|
ConstantInt *OffsetV = cast<ConstantInt>(EmitGEPOffset(&GEP));
|
|
int64_t Offset = OffsetV->getSExtValue();
|
|
|
|
// If this GEP instruction doesn't move the pointer, just replace the GEP
|
|
// with a bitcast of the real input to the dest type.
|
|
if (Offset == 0) {
|
|
// If the bitcast is of an allocation, and the allocation will be
|
|
// converted to match the type of the cast, don't touch this.
|
|
if (isa<AllocaInst>(BCI->getOperand(0)) ||
|
|
isMalloc(BCI->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
// See if the bitcast simplifies, if so, don't nuke this GEP yet.
|
|
if (Instruction *I = visitBitCast(*BCI)) {
|
|
if (I != BCI) {
|
|
I->takeName(BCI);
|
|
BCI->getParent()->getInstList().insert(BCI, I);
|
|
ReplaceInstUsesWith(*BCI, I);
|
|
}
|
|
return &GEP;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return new BitCastInst(BCI->getOperand(0), GEP.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, if the offset is non-zero, we need to find out if there is a
|
|
// field at Offset in 'A's type. If so, we can pull the cast through the
|
|
// GEP.
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 8> NewIndices;
|
|
const Type *InTy =
|
|
cast<PointerType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
if (FindElementAtOffset(InTy, Offset, NewIndices)) {
|
|
Value *NGEP = cast<GEPOperator>(&GEP)->isInBounds() ?
|
|
Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
|
|
NewIndices.end()) :
|
|
Builder->CreateGEP(BCI->getOperand(0), NewIndices.begin(),
|
|
NewIndices.end());
|
|
|
|
if (NGEP->getType() == GEP.getType())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(GEP, NGEP);
|
|
NGEP->takeName(&GEP);
|
|
return new BitCastInst(NGEP, GEP.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitAllocaInst(AllocaInst &AI) {
|
|
// Convert: alloca Ty, C - where C is a constant != 1 into: alloca [C x Ty], 1
|
|
if (AI.isArrayAllocation()) { // Check C != 1
|
|
if (const ConstantInt *C = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(AI.getArraySize())) {
|
|
const Type *NewTy =
|
|
ArrayType::get(AI.getAllocatedType(), C->getZExtValue());
|
|
assert(isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && "Unknown type of allocation inst!");
|
|
AllocaInst *New = Builder->CreateAlloca(NewTy, 0, AI.getName());
|
|
New->setAlignment(AI.getAlignment());
|
|
|
|
// Scan to the end of the allocation instructions, to skip over a block of
|
|
// allocas if possible...also skip interleaved debug info
|
|
//
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator It = New;
|
|
while (isa<AllocaInst>(*It) || isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(*It)) ++It;
|
|
|
|
// Now that I is pointing to the first non-allocation-inst in the block,
|
|
// insert our getelementptr instruction...
|
|
//
|
|
Value *NullIdx =Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(AI.getContext()));
|
|
Value *Idx[2];
|
|
Idx[0] = NullIdx;
|
|
Idx[1] = NullIdx;
|
|
Value *V = GetElementPtrInst::CreateInBounds(New, Idx, Idx + 2,
|
|
New->getName()+".sub", It);
|
|
|
|
// Now make everything use the getelementptr instead of the original
|
|
// allocation.
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, V);
|
|
} else if (isa<UndefValue>(AI.getArraySize())) {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (TD && isa<AllocaInst>(AI) && AI.getAllocatedType()->isSized()) {
|
|
// If alloca'ing a zero byte object, replace the alloca with a null pointer.
|
|
// Note that we only do this for alloca's, because malloc should allocate
|
|
// and return a unique pointer, even for a zero byte allocation.
|
|
if (TD->getTypeAllocSize(AI.getAllocatedType()) == 0)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(AI, Constant::getNullValue(AI.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// If the alignment is 0 (unspecified), assign it the preferred alignment.
|
|
if (AI.getAlignment() == 0)
|
|
AI.setAlignment(TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(AI.getAllocatedType()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitFree(Instruction &FI) {
|
|
Value *Op = FI.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// free undef -> unreachable.
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op)) {
|
|
// Insert a new store to null because we cannot modify the CFG here.
|
|
new StoreInst(ConstantInt::getTrue(FI.getContext()),
|
|
UndefValue::get(Type::getInt1PtrTy(FI.getContext())), &FI);
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If we have 'free null' delete the instruction. This can happen in stl code
|
|
// when lots of inlining happens.
|
|
if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op))
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
|
|
|
|
// If we have a malloc call whose only use is a free call, delete both.
|
|
if (isMalloc(Op)) {
|
|
if (CallInst* CI = extractMallocCallFromBitCast(Op)) {
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse() && CI->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*CI);
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
|
|
}
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Op is a call to malloc
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(FI);
|
|
return EraseInstFromFunction(*cast<Instruction>(Op));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// InstCombineLoadCast - Fold 'load (cast P)' -> cast (load P)' when possible.
|
|
static Instruction *InstCombineLoadCast(InstCombiner &IC, LoadInst &LI,
|
|
const TargetData *TD) {
|
|
User *CI = cast<User>(LI.getOperand(0));
|
|
Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
const PointerType *DestTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType());
|
|
const Type *DestPTy = DestTy->getElementType();
|
|
if (const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType())) {
|
|
|
|
// If the address spaces don't match, don't eliminate the cast.
|
|
if (DestTy->getAddressSpace() != SrcTy->getAddressSpace())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
|
|
|
|
if (DestPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(DestPTy) ||
|
|
isa<VectorType>(DestPTy)) {
|
|
// If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
|
|
// see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
|
|
// constants.
|
|
if (const ArrayType *ASrcTy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy))
|
|
if (Constant *CSrc = dyn_cast<Constant>(CastOp))
|
|
if (ASrcTy->getNumElements() != 0) {
|
|
Value *Idxs[2];
|
|
Idxs[0] = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(LI.getContext()));
|
|
Idxs[1] = Idxs[0];
|
|
CastOp = ConstantExpr::getGetElementPtr(CSrc, Idxs, 2);
|
|
SrcTy = cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
|
|
SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (IC.getTargetData() &&
|
|
(SrcPTy->isInteger() || isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) ||
|
|
isa<VectorType>(SrcPTy)) &&
|
|
// Do not allow turning this into a load of an integer, which is then
|
|
// casted to a pointer, this pessimizes pointer analysis a lot.
|
|
(isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy) == isa<PointerType>(LI.getType())) &&
|
|
IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) ==
|
|
IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy)) {
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
|
|
// the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before the load, cast
|
|
// the result of the loaded value.
|
|
Value *NewLoad =
|
|
IC.Builder->CreateLoad(CastOp, LI.isVolatile(), CI->getName());
|
|
// Now cast the result of the load.
|
|
return new BitCastInst(NewLoad, LI.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitLoadInst(LoadInst &LI) {
|
|
Value *Op = LI.getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
// Attempt to improve the alignment.
|
|
if (TD) {
|
|
unsigned KnownAlign =
|
|
GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Op, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(LI.getType()));
|
|
if (KnownAlign >
|
|
(LI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(LI.getType()) :
|
|
LI.getAlignment()))
|
|
LI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// load (cast X) --> cast (load X) iff safe.
|
|
if (isa<CastInst>(Op))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
|
|
// None of the following transforms are legal for volatile loads.
|
|
if (LI.isVolatile()) return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Do really simple store-to-load forwarding and load CSE, to catch cases
|
|
// where there are several consequtive memory accesses to the same location,
|
|
// separated by a few arithmetic operations.
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &LI;
|
|
if (Value *AvailableVal = FindAvailableLoadedValue(Op, LI.getParent(), BBI,6))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, AvailableVal);
|
|
|
|
// load(gep null, ...) -> unreachable
|
|
if (GetElementPtrInst *GEPI = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Op)) {
|
|
const Value *GEPI0 = GEPI->getOperand(0);
|
|
// TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
|
|
if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(GEPI0) && GEPI->getPointerAddressSpace() == 0){
|
|
// Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate
|
|
// that this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting
|
|
// an unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the
|
|
// CFG.
|
|
new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
|
|
Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// load null/undef -> unreachable
|
|
// TODO: Consider a target hook for valid address spaces for this xform.
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Op) ||
|
|
(isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Op) && LI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0)) {
|
|
// Insert a new store to null instruction before the load to indicate that
|
|
// this code is not reachable. We do this instead of inserting an
|
|
// unreachable instruction directly because we cannot modify the CFG.
|
|
new StoreInst(UndefValue::get(LI.getType()),
|
|
Constant::getNullValue(Op->getType()), &LI);
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(LI, UndefValue::get(LI.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Instcombine load (constantexpr_cast global) -> cast (load global)
|
|
if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Op))
|
|
if (CE->isCast())
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineLoadCast(*this, LI, TD))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
|
|
if (Op->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// Change select and PHI nodes to select values instead of addresses: this
|
|
// helps alias analysis out a lot, allows many others simplifications, and
|
|
// exposes redundancy in the code.
|
|
//
|
|
// Note that we cannot do the transformation unless we know that the
|
|
// introduced loads cannot trap! Something like this is valid as long as
|
|
// the condition is always false: load (select bool %C, int* null, int* %G),
|
|
// but it would not be valid if we transformed it to load from null
|
|
// unconditionally.
|
|
//
|
|
if (SelectInst *SI = dyn_cast<SelectInst>(Op)) {
|
|
// load (select (Cond, &V1, &V2)) --> select(Cond, load &V1, load &V2).
|
|
if (isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(1), SI) &&
|
|
isSafeToLoadUnconditionally(SI->getOperand(2), SI)) {
|
|
Value *V1 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(1),
|
|
SI->getOperand(1)->getName()+".val");
|
|
Value *V2 = Builder->CreateLoad(SI->getOperand(2),
|
|
SI->getOperand(2)->getName()+".val");
|
|
return SelectInst::Create(SI->getCondition(), V1, V2);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// load (select (cond, null, P)) -> load P
|
|
if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(1)))
|
|
if (C->isNullValue()) {
|
|
LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(2));
|
|
return &LI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// load (select (cond, P, null)) -> load P
|
|
if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(SI->getOperand(2)))
|
|
if (C->isNullValue()) {
|
|
LI.setOperand(0, SI->getOperand(1));
|
|
return &LI;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// InstCombineStoreToCast - Fold store V, (cast P) -> store (cast V), P
|
|
/// when possible. This makes it generally easy to do alias analysis and/or
|
|
/// SROA/mem2reg of the memory object.
|
|
static Instruction *InstCombineStoreToCast(InstCombiner &IC, StoreInst &SI) {
|
|
User *CI = cast<User>(SI.getOperand(1));
|
|
Value *CastOp = CI->getOperand(0);
|
|
|
|
const Type *DestPTy = cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getElementType();
|
|
const PointerType *SrcTy = dyn_cast<PointerType>(CastOp->getType());
|
|
if (SrcTy == 0) return 0;
|
|
|
|
const Type *SrcPTy = SrcTy->getElementType();
|
|
|
|
if (!DestPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(DestPTy))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
/// NewGEPIndices - If SrcPTy is an aggregate type, we can emit a "noop gep"
|
|
/// to its first element. This allows us to handle things like:
|
|
/// store i32 xxx, (bitcast {foo*, float}* %P to i32*)
|
|
/// on 32-bit hosts.
|
|
SmallVector<Value*, 4> NewGEPIndices;
|
|
|
|
// If the source is an array, the code below will not succeed. Check to
|
|
// see if a trivial 'gep P, 0, 0' will help matters. Only do this for
|
|
// constants.
|
|
if (isa<ArrayType>(SrcPTy) || isa<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
|
|
// Index through pointer.
|
|
Constant *Zero = Constant::getNullValue(Type::getInt32Ty(SI.getContext()));
|
|
NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
|
|
|
|
while (1) {
|
|
if (const StructType *STy = dyn_cast<StructType>(SrcPTy)) {
|
|
if (!STy->getNumElements()) /* Struct can be empty {} */
|
|
break;
|
|
NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
|
|
SrcPTy = STy->getElementType(0);
|
|
} else if (const ArrayType *ATy = dyn_cast<ArrayType>(SrcPTy)) {
|
|
NewGEPIndices.push_back(Zero);
|
|
SrcPTy = ATy->getElementType();
|
|
} else {
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
SrcTy = PointerType::get(SrcPTy, SrcTy->getAddressSpace());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (!SrcPTy->isInteger() && !isa<PointerType>(SrcPTy))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// If the pointers point into different address spaces or if they point to
|
|
// values with different sizes, we can't do the transformation.
|
|
if (!IC.getTargetData() ||
|
|
SrcTy->getAddressSpace() !=
|
|
cast<PointerType>(CI->getType())->getAddressSpace() ||
|
|
IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(SrcPTy) !=
|
|
IC.getTargetData()->getTypeSizeInBits(DestPTy))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we are casting from one integer or pointer type to another of
|
|
// the same size. Instead of casting the pointer before
|
|
// the store, cast the value to be stored.
|
|
Value *NewCast;
|
|
Value *SIOp0 = SI.getOperand(0);
|
|
Instruction::CastOps opcode = Instruction::BitCast;
|
|
const Type* CastSrcTy = SIOp0->getType();
|
|
const Type* CastDstTy = SrcPTy;
|
|
if (isa<PointerType>(CastDstTy)) {
|
|
if (CastSrcTy->isInteger())
|
|
opcode = Instruction::IntToPtr;
|
|
} else if (isa<IntegerType>(CastDstTy)) {
|
|
if (isa<PointerType>(SIOp0->getType()))
|
|
opcode = Instruction::PtrToInt;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// SIOp0 is a pointer to aggregate and this is a store to the first field,
|
|
// emit a GEP to index into its first field.
|
|
if (!NewGEPIndices.empty())
|
|
CastOp = IC.Builder->CreateInBoundsGEP(CastOp, NewGEPIndices.begin(),
|
|
NewGEPIndices.end());
|
|
|
|
NewCast = IC.Builder->CreateCast(opcode, SIOp0, CastDstTy,
|
|
SIOp0->getName()+".c");
|
|
return new StoreInst(NewCast, CastOp);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// equivalentAddressValues - Test if A and B will obviously have the same
|
|
/// value. This includes recognizing that %t0 and %t1 will have the same
|
|
/// value in code like this:
|
|
/// %t0 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
|
|
/// store i32 0, i32* %t0
|
|
/// %t1 = getelementptr \@a, 0, 3
|
|
/// %t2 = load i32* %t1
|
|
///
|
|
static bool equivalentAddressValues(Value *A, Value *B) {
|
|
// Test if the values are trivially equivalent.
|
|
if (A == B) return true;
|
|
|
|
// Test if the values come form identical arithmetic instructions.
|
|
// This uses isIdenticalToWhenDefined instead of isIdenticalTo because
|
|
// its only used to compare two uses within the same basic block, which
|
|
// means that they'll always either have the same value or one of them
|
|
// will have an undefined value.
|
|
if (isa<BinaryOperator>(A) ||
|
|
isa<CastInst>(A) ||
|
|
isa<PHINode>(A) ||
|
|
isa<GetElementPtrInst>(A))
|
|
if (Instruction *BI = dyn_cast<Instruction>(B))
|
|
if (cast<Instruction>(A)->isIdenticalToWhenDefined(BI))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise they may not be equivalent.
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this instruction has two uses, one of which is a llvm.dbg.declare,
|
|
// return the llvm.dbg.declare.
|
|
DbgDeclareInst *InstCombiner::hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Value *V) {
|
|
if (!V->hasNUses(2))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
for (Value::use_iterator UI = V->use_begin(), E = V->use_end();
|
|
UI != E; ++UI) {
|
|
if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI))
|
|
return DI;
|
|
if (isa<BitCastInst>(UI) && UI->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = dyn_cast<DbgDeclareInst>(UI->use_begin()))
|
|
return DI;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitStoreInst(StoreInst &SI) {
|
|
Value *Val = SI.getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *Ptr = SI.getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// If the RHS is an alloca with a single use, zapify the store, making the
|
|
// alloca dead.
|
|
// If the RHS is an alloca with a two uses, the other one being a
|
|
// llvm.dbg.declare, zapify the store and the declare, making the
|
|
// alloca dead. We must do this to prevent declare's from affecting
|
|
// codegen.
|
|
if (!SI.isVolatile()) {
|
|
if (Ptr->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
if (isa<AllocaInst>(Ptr)) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (GetElementPtrInst *GEP = dyn_cast<GetElementPtrInst>(Ptr)) {
|
|
if (isa<AllocaInst>(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (GEP->getOperand(0)->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(GEP->getOperand(0))) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
if (DbgDeclareInst *DI = hasOneUsePlusDeclare(Ptr)) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*DI);
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Attempt to improve the alignment.
|
|
if (TD) {
|
|
unsigned KnownAlign =
|
|
GetOrEnforceKnownAlignment(Ptr, TD->getPrefTypeAlignment(Val->getType()));
|
|
if (KnownAlign >
|
|
(SI.getAlignment() == 0 ? TD->getABITypeAlignment(Val->getType()) :
|
|
SI.getAlignment()))
|
|
SI.setAlignment(KnownAlign);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Do really simple DSE, to catch cases where there are several consecutive
|
|
// stores to the same location, separated by a few arithmetic operations. This
|
|
// situation often occurs with bitfield accesses.
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BBI = &SI;
|
|
for (unsigned ScanInsts = 6; BBI != SI.getParent()->begin() && ScanInsts;
|
|
--ScanInsts) {
|
|
--BBI;
|
|
// Don't count debug info directives, lest they affect codegen,
|
|
// and we skip pointer-to-pointer bitcasts, which are NOPs.
|
|
// It is necessary for correctness to skip those that feed into a
|
|
// llvm.dbg.declare, as these are not present when debugging is off.
|
|
if (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
|
|
(isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
|
|
ScanInsts++;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (StoreInst *PrevSI = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI)) {
|
|
// Prev store isn't volatile, and stores to the same location?
|
|
if (!PrevSI->isVolatile() &&equivalentAddressValues(PrevSI->getOperand(1),
|
|
SI.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
++NumDeadStore;
|
|
++BBI;
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*PrevSI);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this is a load, we have to stop. However, if the loaded value is from
|
|
// the pointer we're loading and is producing the pointer we're storing,
|
|
// then *this* store is dead (X = load P; store X -> P).
|
|
if (LoadInst *LI = dyn_cast<LoadInst>(BBI)) {
|
|
if (LI == Val && equivalentAddressValues(LI->getOperand(0), Ptr) &&
|
|
!SI.isVolatile()) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
// Otherwise, this is a load from some other location. Stores before it
|
|
// may not be dead.
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Don't skip over loads or things that can modify memory.
|
|
if (BBI->mayWriteToMemory() || BBI->mayReadFromMemory())
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (SI.isVolatile()) return 0; // Don't hack volatile stores.
|
|
|
|
// store X, null -> turns into 'unreachable' in SimplifyCFG
|
|
if (isa<ConstantPointerNull>(Ptr) && SI.getPointerAddressSpace() == 0) {
|
|
if (!isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
|
|
SI.setOperand(0, UndefValue::get(Val->getType()));
|
|
if (Instruction *U = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Val))
|
|
Worklist.Add(U); // Dropped a use.
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
}
|
|
return 0; // Do not modify these!
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// store undef, Ptr -> noop
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(Val)) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the pointer destination is a cast, see if we can fold the cast into the
|
|
// source instead.
|
|
if (isa<CastInst>(Ptr))
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
if (ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(Ptr))
|
|
if (CE->isCast())
|
|
if (Instruction *Res = InstCombineStoreToCast(*this, SI))
|
|
return Res;
|
|
|
|
|
|
// If this store is the last instruction in the basic block (possibly
|
|
// excepting debug info instructions and the pointer bitcasts that feed
|
|
// into them), and if the block ends with an unconditional branch, try
|
|
// to move it to the successor block.
|
|
BBI = &SI;
|
|
do {
|
|
++BBI;
|
|
} while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
|
|
(isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType())));
|
|
if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI))
|
|
if (BI->isUnconditional())
|
|
if (SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(SI))
|
|
return 0; // xform done!
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock - Turn things like:
|
|
/// if () { *P = v1; } else { *P = v2 }
|
|
/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
|
|
///
|
|
/// Simplify things like:
|
|
/// *P = v1; if () { *P = v2; }
|
|
/// into a phi node with a store in the successor.
|
|
///
|
|
bool InstCombiner::SimplifyStoreAtEndOfBlock(StoreInst &SI) {
|
|
BasicBlock *StoreBB = SI.getParent();
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if the successor block has exactly two incoming edges. If
|
|
// so, see if the other predecessor contains a store to the same location.
|
|
// if so, insert a PHI node (if needed) and move the stores down.
|
|
BasicBlock *DestBB = StoreBB->getTerminator()->getSuccessor(0);
|
|
|
|
// Determine whether Dest has exactly two predecessors and, if so, compute
|
|
// the other predecessor.
|
|
pred_iterator PI = pred_begin(DestBB);
|
|
BasicBlock *OtherBB = 0;
|
|
if (*PI != StoreBB)
|
|
OtherBB = *PI;
|
|
++PI;
|
|
if (PI == pred_end(DestBB))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
if (*PI != StoreBB) {
|
|
if (OtherBB)
|
|
return false;
|
|
OtherBB = *PI;
|
|
}
|
|
if (++PI != pred_end(DestBB))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Bail out if all the relevant blocks aren't distinct (this can happen,
|
|
// for example, if SI is in an infinite loop)
|
|
if (StoreBB == DestBB || OtherBB == DestBB)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Verify that the other block ends in a branch and is not otherwise empty.
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator BBI = OtherBB->getTerminator();
|
|
BranchInst *OtherBr = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(BBI);
|
|
if (!OtherBr || BBI == OtherBB->begin())
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// If the other block ends in an unconditional branch, check for the 'if then
|
|
// else' case. there is an instruction before the branch.
|
|
StoreInst *OtherStore = 0;
|
|
if (OtherBr->isUnconditional()) {
|
|
--BBI;
|
|
// Skip over debugging info.
|
|
while (isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(BBI) ||
|
|
(isa<BitCastInst>(BBI) && isa<PointerType>(BBI->getType()))) {
|
|
if (BBI==OtherBB->begin())
|
|
return false;
|
|
--BBI;
|
|
}
|
|
// If this isn't a store, isn't a store to the same location, or if the
|
|
// alignments differ, bail out.
|
|
OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI);
|
|
if (!OtherStore || OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1) ||
|
|
OtherStore->getAlignment() != SI.getAlignment())
|
|
return false;
|
|
} else {
|
|
// Otherwise, the other block ended with a conditional branch. If one of the
|
|
// destinations is StoreBB, then we have the if/then case.
|
|
if (OtherBr->getSuccessor(0) != StoreBB &&
|
|
OtherBr->getSuccessor(1) != StoreBB)
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Okay, we know that OtherBr now goes to Dest and StoreBB, so this is an
|
|
// if/then triangle. See if there is a store to the same ptr as SI that
|
|
// lives in OtherBB.
|
|
for (;; --BBI) {
|
|
// Check to see if we find the matching store.
|
|
if ((OtherStore = dyn_cast<StoreInst>(BBI))) {
|
|
if (OtherStore->getOperand(1) != SI.getOperand(1) ||
|
|
OtherStore->getAlignment() != SI.getAlignment())
|
|
return false;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
// If we find something that may be using or overwriting the stored
|
|
// value, or if we run out of instructions, we can't do the xform.
|
|
if (BBI->mayReadFromMemory() || BBI->mayWriteToMemory() ||
|
|
BBI == OtherBB->begin())
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// In order to eliminate the store in OtherBr, we have to
|
|
// make sure nothing reads or overwrites the stored value in
|
|
// StoreBB.
|
|
for (BasicBlock::iterator I = StoreBB->begin(); &*I != &SI; ++I) {
|
|
// FIXME: This should really be AA driven.
|
|
if (I->mayReadFromMemory() || I->mayWriteToMemory())
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Insert a PHI node now if we need it.
|
|
Value *MergedVal = OtherStore->getOperand(0);
|
|
if (MergedVal != SI.getOperand(0)) {
|
|
PHINode *PN = PHINode::Create(MergedVal->getType(), "storemerge");
|
|
PN->reserveOperandSpace(2);
|
|
PN->addIncoming(SI.getOperand(0), SI.getParent());
|
|
PN->addIncoming(OtherStore->getOperand(0), OtherBB);
|
|
MergedVal = InsertNewInstBefore(PN, DestBB->front());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Advance to a place where it is safe to insert the new store and
|
|
// insert it.
|
|
BBI = DestBB->getFirstNonPHI();
|
|
InsertNewInstBefore(new StoreInst(MergedVal, SI.getOperand(1),
|
|
OtherStore->isVolatile(),
|
|
SI.getAlignment()), *BBI);
|
|
|
|
// Nuke the old stores.
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(SI);
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*OtherStore);
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitBranchInst(BranchInst &BI) {
|
|
// Change br (not X), label True, label False to: br X, label False, True
|
|
Value *X = 0;
|
|
BasicBlock *TrueDest;
|
|
BasicBlock *FalseDest;
|
|
if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_Not(m_Value(X)), TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
|
|
!isa<Constant>(X)) {
|
|
// Swap Destinations and condition...
|
|
BI.setCondition(X);
|
|
BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
|
|
BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
|
|
return &BI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Cannonicalize fcmp_one -> fcmp_oeq
|
|
FCmpInst::Predicate FPred; Value *Y;
|
|
if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_FCmp(FPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
|
|
TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
|
|
BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
|
|
if (FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_ONE || FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OLE ||
|
|
FPred == FCmpInst::FCMP_OGE) {
|
|
FCmpInst *Cond = cast<FCmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
|
|
Cond->setPredicate(FCmpInst::getInversePredicate(FPred));
|
|
|
|
// Swap Destinations and condition.
|
|
BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
|
|
BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
|
|
Worklist.Add(Cond);
|
|
return &BI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Cannonicalize icmp_ne -> icmp_eq
|
|
ICmpInst::Predicate IPred;
|
|
if (match(&BI, m_Br(m_ICmp(IPred, m_Value(X), m_Value(Y)),
|
|
TrueDest, FalseDest)) &&
|
|
BI.getCondition()->hasOneUse())
|
|
if (IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_NE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_ULE ||
|
|
IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SLE || IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_UGE ||
|
|
IPred == ICmpInst::ICMP_SGE) {
|
|
ICmpInst *Cond = cast<ICmpInst>(BI.getCondition());
|
|
Cond->setPredicate(ICmpInst::getInversePredicate(IPred));
|
|
// Swap Destinations and condition.
|
|
BI.setSuccessor(0, FalseDest);
|
|
BI.setSuccessor(1, TrueDest);
|
|
Worklist.Add(Cond);
|
|
return &BI;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitSwitchInst(SwitchInst &SI) {
|
|
Value *Cond = SI.getCondition();
|
|
if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(Cond)) {
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Add)
|
|
if (ConstantInt *AddRHS = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(1))) {
|
|
// change 'switch (X+4) case 1:' into 'switch (X) case -3'
|
|
for (unsigned i = 2, e = SI.getNumOperands(); i != e; i += 2)
|
|
SI.setOperand(i,
|
|
ConstantExpr::getSub(cast<Constant>(SI.getOperand(i)),
|
|
AddRHS));
|
|
SI.setOperand(0, I->getOperand(0));
|
|
Worklist.Add(I);
|
|
return &SI;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractValueInst(ExtractValueInst &EV) {
|
|
Value *Agg = EV.getAggregateOperand();
|
|
|
|
if (!EV.hasIndices())
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Agg);
|
|
|
|
if (Constant *C = dyn_cast<Constant>(Agg)) {
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(C))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, UndefValue::get(EV.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(C))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, Constant::getNullValue(EV.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (isa<ConstantArray>(C) || isa<ConstantStruct>(C)) {
|
|
// Extract the element indexed by the first index out of the constant
|
|
Value *V = C->getOperand(*EV.idx_begin());
|
|
if (EV.getNumIndices() > 1)
|
|
// Extract the remaining indices out of the constant indexed by the
|
|
// first index
|
|
return ExtractValueInst::Create(V, EV.idx_begin() + 1, EV.idx_end());
|
|
else
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, V);
|
|
}
|
|
return 0; // Can't handle other constants
|
|
}
|
|
if (InsertValueInst *IV = dyn_cast<InsertValueInst>(Agg)) {
|
|
// We're extracting from an insertvalue instruction, compare the indices
|
|
const unsigned *exti, *exte, *insi, *inse;
|
|
for (exti = EV.idx_begin(), insi = IV->idx_begin(),
|
|
exte = EV.idx_end(), inse = IV->idx_end();
|
|
exti != exte && insi != inse;
|
|
++exti, ++insi) {
|
|
if (*insi != *exti)
|
|
// The insert and extract both reference distinctly different elements.
|
|
// This means the extract is not influenced by the insert, and we can
|
|
// replace the aggregate operand of the extract with the aggregate
|
|
// operand of the insert. i.e., replace
|
|
// %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
|
|
// %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 0
|
|
// with
|
|
// %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 0
|
|
return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
|
|
EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
|
|
}
|
|
if (exti == exte && insi == inse)
|
|
// Both iterators are at the end: Index lists are identical. Replace
|
|
// %B = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
|
|
// %C = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %B, 1, 0
|
|
// with "i32 42"
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand());
|
|
if (exti == exte) {
|
|
// The extract list is a prefix of the insert list. i.e. replace
|
|
// %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, i32 42, 1, 0
|
|
// %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1
|
|
// with
|
|
// %X = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, 1
|
|
// %E = insertvalue { i32 } %X, i32 42, 0
|
|
// by switching the order of the insert and extract (though the
|
|
// insertvalue should be left in, since it may have other uses).
|
|
Value *NewEV = Builder->CreateExtractValue(IV->getAggregateOperand(),
|
|
EV.idx_begin(), EV.idx_end());
|
|
return InsertValueInst::Create(NewEV, IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
|
|
insi, inse);
|
|
}
|
|
if (insi == inse)
|
|
// The insert list is a prefix of the extract list
|
|
// We can simply remove the common indices from the extract and make it
|
|
// operate on the inserted value instead of the insertvalue result.
|
|
// i.e., replace
|
|
// %I = insertvalue { i32, { i32 } } %A, { i32 } { i32 42 }, 1
|
|
// %E = extractvalue { i32, { i32 } } %I, 1, 0
|
|
// with
|
|
// %E extractvalue { i32 } { i32 42 }, 0
|
|
return ExtractValueInst::Create(IV->getInsertedValueOperand(),
|
|
exti, exte);
|
|
}
|
|
if (IntrinsicInst *II = dyn_cast<IntrinsicInst>(Agg)) {
|
|
// We're extracting from an intrinsic, see if we're the only user, which
|
|
// allows us to simplify multiple result intrinsics to simpler things that
|
|
// just get one value..
|
|
if (II->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
// Check if we're grabbing the overflow bit or the result of a 'with
|
|
// overflow' intrinsic. If it's the latter we can remove the intrinsic
|
|
// and replace it with a traditional binary instruction.
|
|
switch (II->getIntrinsicID()) {
|
|
case Intrinsic::uadd_with_overflow:
|
|
case Intrinsic::sadd_with_overflow:
|
|
if (*EV.idx_begin() == 0) { // Normal result.
|
|
Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
|
|
II->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*II);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateAdd(LHS, RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::usub_with_overflow:
|
|
case Intrinsic::ssub_with_overflow:
|
|
if (*EV.idx_begin() == 0) { // Normal result.
|
|
Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
|
|
II->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*II);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateSub(LHS, RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
case Intrinsic::umul_with_overflow:
|
|
case Intrinsic::smul_with_overflow:
|
|
if (*EV.idx_begin() == 0) { // Normal result.
|
|
Value *LHS = II->getOperand(1), *RHS = II->getOperand(2);
|
|
II->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(II->getType()));
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*II);
|
|
return BinaryOperator::CreateMul(LHS, RHS);
|
|
}
|
|
break;
|
|
default:
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// Can't simplify extracts from other values. Note that nested extracts are
|
|
// already simplified implicitely by the above (extract ( extract (insert) )
|
|
// will be translated into extract ( insert ( extract ) ) first and then just
|
|
// the value inserted, if appropriate).
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// CheapToScalarize - Return true if the value is cheaper to scalarize than it
|
|
/// is to leave as a vector operation.
|
|
static bool CheapToScalarize(Value *V, bool isConstant) {
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
|
|
return true;
|
|
if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V)) {
|
|
if (isConstant) return true;
|
|
// If all elts are the same, we can extract.
|
|
Constant *Op0 = C->getOperand(0);
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1; i < C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
|
|
if (C->getOperand(i) != Op0)
|
|
return false;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(V);
|
|
if (!I) return false;
|
|
|
|
// Insert element gets simplified to the inserted element or is deleted if
|
|
// this is constant idx extract element and its a constant idx insertelt.
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::InsertElement && isConstant &&
|
|
isa<ConstantInt>(I->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return true;
|
|
if (I->getOpcode() == Instruction::Load && I->hasOneUse())
|
|
return true;
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I))
|
|
if (BO->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
(CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
|
|
CheapToScalarize(BO->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
|
|
return true;
|
|
if (CmpInst *CI = dyn_cast<CmpInst>(I))
|
|
if (CI->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
(CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(0), isConstant) ||
|
|
CheapToScalarize(CI->getOperand(1), isConstant)))
|
|
return true;
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// Read and decode a shufflevector mask.
|
|
///
|
|
/// It turns undef elements into values that are larger than the number of
|
|
/// elements in the input.
|
|
static std::vector<unsigned> getShuffleMask(const ShuffleVectorInst *SVI) {
|
|
unsigned NElts = SVI->getType()->getNumElements();
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 0);
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return std::vector<unsigned>(NElts, 2*NElts);
|
|
|
|
std::vector<unsigned> Result;
|
|
const ConstantVector *CP = cast<ConstantVector>(SVI->getOperand(2));
|
|
for (User::const_op_iterator i = CP->op_begin(), e = CP->op_end(); i!=e; ++i)
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(*i))
|
|
Result.push_back(NElts*2); // undef -> 8
|
|
else
|
|
Result.push_back(cast<ConstantInt>(*i)->getZExtValue());
|
|
return Result;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// FindScalarElement - Given a vector and an element number, see if the scalar
|
|
/// value is already around as a register, for example if it were inserted then
|
|
/// extracted from the vector.
|
|
static Value *FindScalarElement(Value *V, unsigned EltNo) {
|
|
assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) && "Not looking at a vector?");
|
|
const VectorType *PTy = cast<VectorType>(V->getType());
|
|
unsigned Width = PTy->getNumElements();
|
|
if (EltNo >= Width) // Out of range access.
|
|
return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(V))
|
|
return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
|
|
else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V))
|
|
return Constant::getNullValue(PTy->getElementType());
|
|
else if (ConstantVector *CP = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(V))
|
|
return CP->getOperand(EltNo);
|
|
else if (InsertElementInst *III = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
|
|
// If this is an insert to a variable element, we don't know what it is.
|
|
if (!isa<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2)))
|
|
return 0;
|
|
unsigned IIElt = cast<ConstantInt>(III->getOperand(2))->getZExtValue();
|
|
|
|
// If this is an insert to the element we are looking for, return the
|
|
// inserted value.
|
|
if (EltNo == IIElt)
|
|
return III->getOperand(1);
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, the insertelement doesn't modify the value, recurse on its
|
|
// vector input.
|
|
return FindScalarElement(III->getOperand(0), EltNo);
|
|
} else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(V)) {
|
|
unsigned LHSWidth =
|
|
cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
unsigned InEl = getShuffleMask(SVI)[EltNo];
|
|
if (InEl < LHSWidth)
|
|
return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(0), InEl);
|
|
else if (InEl < LHSWidth*2)
|
|
return FindScalarElement(SVI->getOperand(1), InEl - LHSWidth);
|
|
else
|
|
return UndefValue::get(PTy->getElementType());
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, we don't know.
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitExtractElementInst(ExtractElementInst &EI) {
|
|
// If vector val is undef, replace extract with scalar undef.
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(EI.getOperand(0)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// If vector val is constant 0, replace extract with scalar 0.
|
|
if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(EI.getOperand(0)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Constant::getNullValue(EI.getType()));
|
|
|
|
if (ConstantVector *C = dyn_cast<ConstantVector>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
|
|
// If vector val is constant with all elements the same, replace EI with
|
|
// that element. When the elements are not identical, we cannot replace yet
|
|
// (we do that below, but only when the index is constant).
|
|
Constant *op0 = C->getOperand(0);
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1; i != C->getNumOperands(); ++i)
|
|
if (C->getOperand(i) != op0) {
|
|
op0 = 0;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
if (op0)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, op0);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If extracting a specified index from the vector, see if we can recursively
|
|
// find a previously computed scalar that was inserted into the vector.
|
|
if (ConstantInt *IdxC = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
unsigned IndexVal = IdxC->getZExtValue();
|
|
unsigned VectorWidth = EI.getVectorOperandType()->getNumElements();
|
|
|
|
// If this is extracting an invalid index, turn this into undef, to avoid
|
|
// crashing the code below.
|
|
if (IndexVal >= VectorWidth)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// This instruction only demands the single element from the input vector.
|
|
// If the input vector has a single use, simplify it based on this use
|
|
// property.
|
|
if (EI.getOperand(0)->hasOneUse() && VectorWidth != 1) {
|
|
APInt UndefElts(VectorWidth, 0);
|
|
APInt DemandedMask(VectorWidth, 1 << IndexVal);
|
|
if (Value *V = SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(EI.getOperand(0),
|
|
DemandedMask, UndefElts)) {
|
|
EI.setOperand(0, V);
|
|
return &EI;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(EI.getOperand(0), IndexVal))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, Elt);
|
|
|
|
// If the this extractelement is directly using a bitcast from a vector of
|
|
// the same number of elements, see if we can find the source element from
|
|
// it. In this case, we will end up needing to bitcast the scalars.
|
|
if (BitCastInst *BCI = dyn_cast<BitCastInst>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
|
|
if (const VectorType *VT =
|
|
dyn_cast<VectorType>(BCI->getOperand(0)->getType()))
|
|
if (VT->getNumElements() == VectorWidth)
|
|
if (Value *Elt = FindScalarElement(BCI->getOperand(0), IndexVal))
|
|
return new BitCastInst(Elt, EI.getType());
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *I = dyn_cast<Instruction>(EI.getOperand(0))) {
|
|
// Push extractelement into predecessor operation if legal and
|
|
// profitable to do so
|
|
if (BinaryOperator *BO = dyn_cast<BinaryOperator>(I)) {
|
|
if (I->hasOneUse() &&
|
|
CheapToScalarize(BO, isa<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1)))) {
|
|
Value *newEI0 =
|
|
Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(0), EI.getOperand(1),
|
|
EI.getName()+".lhs");
|
|
Value *newEI1 =
|
|
Builder->CreateExtractElement(BO->getOperand(1), EI.getOperand(1),
|
|
EI.getName()+".rhs");
|
|
return BinaryOperator::Create(BO->getOpcode(), newEI0, newEI1);
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (InsertElementInst *IE = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(I)) {
|
|
// Extracting the inserted element?
|
|
if (IE->getOperand(2) == EI.getOperand(1))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, IE->getOperand(1));
|
|
// If the inserted and extracted elements are constants, they must not
|
|
// be the same value, extract from the pre-inserted value instead.
|
|
if (isa<Constant>(IE->getOperand(2)) && isa<Constant>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
Worklist.AddValue(EI.getOperand(0));
|
|
EI.setOperand(0, IE->getOperand(0));
|
|
return &EI;
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (ShuffleVectorInst *SVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(I)) {
|
|
// If this is extracting an element from a shufflevector, figure out where
|
|
// it came from and extract from the appropriate input element instead.
|
|
if (ConstantInt *Elt = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(EI.getOperand(1))) {
|
|
unsigned SrcIdx = getShuffleMask(SVI)[Elt->getZExtValue()];
|
|
Value *Src;
|
|
unsigned LHSWidth =
|
|
cast<VectorType>(SVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
|
|
if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth)
|
|
Src = SVI->getOperand(0);
|
|
else if (SrcIdx < LHSWidth*2) {
|
|
SrcIdx -= LHSWidth;
|
|
Src = SVI->getOperand(1);
|
|
} else {
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(EI, UndefValue::get(EI.getType()));
|
|
}
|
|
return ExtractElementInst::Create(Src,
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(EI.getContext()),
|
|
SrcIdx, false));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// FIXME: Canonicalize extractelement(bitcast) -> bitcast(extractelement)
|
|
}
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// CollectSingleShuffleElements - If V is a shuffle of values that ONLY returns
|
|
/// elements from either LHS or RHS, return the shuffle mask and true.
|
|
/// Otherwise, return false.
|
|
static bool CollectSingleShuffleElements(Value *V, Value *LHS, Value *RHS,
|
|
std::vector<Constant*> &Mask) {
|
|
assert(V->getType() == LHS->getType() && V->getType() == RHS->getType() &&
|
|
"Invalid CollectSingleShuffleElements");
|
|
unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
|
|
Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext())));
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (V == LHS) {
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
|
|
Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()), i));
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (V == RHS) {
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
|
|
Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()),
|
|
i+NumElts));
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
|
|
// If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
|
|
Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
|
|
|
|
if (!isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp))
|
|
return false;
|
|
unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp)) { // inserting undef into vector.
|
|
// Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
|
|
// transitively ok.
|
|
if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
|
|
// If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted undef.
|
|
Mask[InsertedIdx] = UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()));
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)){
|
|
if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) &&
|
|
EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
|
|
unsigned ExtractedIdx =
|
|
cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
|
|
|
|
// This must be extracting from either LHS or RHS.
|
|
if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS || EI->getOperand(0) == RHS) {
|
|
// Okay, we can handle this if the vector we are insertinting into is
|
|
// transitively ok.
|
|
if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(VecOp, LHS, RHS, Mask)) {
|
|
// If so, update the mask to reflect the inserted value.
|
|
if (EI->getOperand(0) == LHS) {
|
|
Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()),
|
|
ExtractedIdx);
|
|
} else {
|
|
assert(EI->getOperand(0) == RHS);
|
|
Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()),
|
|
ExtractedIdx+NumElts);
|
|
|
|
}
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
|
|
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
/// CollectShuffleElements - We are building a shuffle of V, using RHS as the
|
|
/// RHS of the shuffle instruction, if it is not null. Return a shuffle mask
|
|
/// that computes V and the LHS value of the shuffle.
|
|
static Value *CollectShuffleElements(Value *V, std::vector<Constant*> &Mask,
|
|
Value *&RHS) {
|
|
assert(isa<VectorType>(V->getType()) &&
|
|
(RHS == 0 || V->getType() == RHS->getType()) &&
|
|
"Invalid shuffle!");
|
|
unsigned NumElts = cast<VectorType>(V->getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(V)) {
|
|
Mask.assign(NumElts, UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext())));
|
|
return V;
|
|
} else if (isa<ConstantAggregateZero>(V)) {
|
|
Mask.assign(NumElts, ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()),0));
|
|
return V;
|
|
} else if (InsertElementInst *IEI = dyn_cast<InsertElementInst>(V)) {
|
|
// If this is an insert of an extract from some other vector, include it.
|
|
Value *VecOp = IEI->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *ScalarOp = IEI->getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *IdxOp = IEI->getOperand(2);
|
|
|
|
if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
|
|
if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
|
|
EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == V->getType()) {
|
|
unsigned ExtractedIdx =
|
|
cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
|
|
unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
|
|
|
|
// Either the extracted from or inserted into vector must be RHSVec,
|
|
// otherwise we'd end up with a shuffle of three inputs.
|
|
if (EI->getOperand(0) == RHS || RHS == 0) {
|
|
RHS = EI->getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(VecOp, Mask, RHS);
|
|
Mask[InsertedIdx % NumElts] =
|
|
ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()),
|
|
NumElts+ExtractedIdx);
|
|
return V;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
if (VecOp == RHS) {
|
|
Value *V = CollectShuffleElements(EI->getOperand(0), Mask, RHS);
|
|
// Everything but the extracted element is replaced with the RHS.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i) {
|
|
if (i != InsertedIdx)
|
|
Mask[i] = ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()),
|
|
NumElts+i);
|
|
}
|
|
return V;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If this insertelement is a chain that comes from exactly these two
|
|
// vectors, return the vector and the effective shuffle.
|
|
if (CollectSingleShuffleElements(IEI, EI->getOperand(0), RHS, Mask))
|
|
return EI->getOperand(0);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
// TODO: Handle shufflevector here!
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise, can't do anything fancy. Return an identity vector.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0; i != NumElts; ++i)
|
|
Mask.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(V->getContext()), i));
|
|
return V;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitInsertElementInst(InsertElementInst &IE) {
|
|
Value *VecOp = IE.getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *ScalarOp = IE.getOperand(1);
|
|
Value *IdxOp = IE.getOperand(2);
|
|
|
|
// Inserting an undef or into an undefined place, remove this.
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(ScalarOp) || isa<UndefValue>(IdxOp))
|
|
ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
|
|
|
|
// If the inserted element was extracted from some other vector, and if the
|
|
// indexes are constant, try to turn this into a shufflevector operation.
|
|
if (ExtractElementInst *EI = dyn_cast<ExtractElementInst>(ScalarOp)) {
|
|
if (isa<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1)) && isa<ConstantInt>(IdxOp) &&
|
|
EI->getOperand(0)->getType() == IE.getType()) {
|
|
unsigned NumVectorElts = IE.getType()->getNumElements();
|
|
unsigned ExtractedIdx =
|
|
cast<ConstantInt>(EI->getOperand(1))->getZExtValue();
|
|
unsigned InsertedIdx = cast<ConstantInt>(IdxOp)->getZExtValue();
|
|
|
|
if (ExtractedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range extract.
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
|
|
|
|
if (InsertedIdx >= NumVectorElts) // Out of range insert.
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, UndefValue::get(IE.getType()));
|
|
|
|
// If we are extracting a value from a vector, then inserting it right
|
|
// back into the same place, just use the input vector.
|
|
if (EI->getOperand(0) == VecOp && ExtractedIdx == InsertedIdx)
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(IE, VecOp);
|
|
|
|
// If this insertelement isn't used by some other insertelement, turn it
|
|
// (and any insertelements it points to), into one big shuffle.
|
|
if (!IE.hasOneUse() || !isa<InsertElementInst>(IE.use_back())) {
|
|
std::vector<Constant*> Mask;
|
|
Value *RHS = 0;
|
|
Value *LHS = CollectShuffleElements(&IE, Mask, RHS);
|
|
if (RHS == 0) RHS = UndefValue::get(LHS->getType());
|
|
// We now have a shuffle of LHS, RHS, Mask.
|
|
return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHS, RHS,
|
|
ConstantVector::get(Mask));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(VecOp->getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
|
|
APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&IE, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts))
|
|
return &IE;
|
|
|
|
return 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
Instruction *InstCombiner::visitShuffleVectorInst(ShuffleVectorInst &SVI) {
|
|
Value *LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
|
|
Value *RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
|
|
std::vector<unsigned> Mask = getShuffleMask(&SVI);
|
|
|
|
bool MadeChange = false;
|
|
|
|
// Undefined shuffle mask -> undefined value.
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(SVI.getOperand(2)))
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, UndefValue::get(SVI.getType()));
|
|
|
|
unsigned VWidth = cast<VectorType>(SVI.getType())->getNumElements();
|
|
|
|
if (VWidth != cast<VectorType>(LHS->getType())->getNumElements())
|
|
return 0;
|
|
|
|
APInt UndefElts(VWidth, 0);
|
|
APInt AllOnesEltMask(APInt::getAllOnesValue(VWidth));
|
|
if (SimplifyDemandedVectorElts(&SVI, AllOnesEltMask, UndefElts)) {
|
|
LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
|
|
RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
|
|
MadeChange = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Canonicalize shuffle(x ,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask')
|
|
// Canonicalize shuffle(undef,x,mask) -> shuffle(x, undef,mask').
|
|
if (LHS == RHS || isa<UndefValue>(LHS)) {
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(LHS) && LHS == RHS) {
|
|
// shuffle(undef,undef,mask) -> undef.
|
|
return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Remap any references to RHS to use LHS.
|
|
std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
if (Mask[i] >= 2*e)
|
|
Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(SVI.getContext())));
|
|
else {
|
|
if ((Mask[i] >= e && isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) ||
|
|
(Mask[i] < e && isa<UndefValue>(LHS))) {
|
|
Mask[i] = 2*e; // Turn into undef.
|
|
Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(Type::getInt32Ty(SVI.getContext())));
|
|
} else {
|
|
Mask[i] = Mask[i] % e; // Force to LHS.
|
|
Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(Type::getInt32Ty(SVI.getContext()),
|
|
Mask[i]));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
SVI.setOperand(0, SVI.getOperand(1));
|
|
SVI.setOperand(1, UndefValue::get(RHS->getType()));
|
|
SVI.setOperand(2, ConstantVector::get(Elts));
|
|
LHS = SVI.getOperand(0);
|
|
RHS = SVI.getOperand(1);
|
|
MadeChange = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Analyze the shuffle, are the LHS or RHS and identity shuffles?
|
|
bool isLHSID = true, isRHSID = true;
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
if (Mask[i] >= e*2) continue; // Ignore undef values.
|
|
// Is this an identity shuffle of the LHS value?
|
|
isLHSID &= (Mask[i] == i);
|
|
|
|
// Is this an identity shuffle of the RHS value?
|
|
isRHSID &= (Mask[i]-e == i);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Eliminate identity shuffles.
|
|
if (isLHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, LHS);
|
|
if (isRHSID) return ReplaceInstUsesWith(SVI, RHS);
|
|
|
|
// If the LHS is a shufflevector itself, see if we can combine it with this
|
|
// one without producing an unusual shuffle. Here we are really conservative:
|
|
// we are absolutely afraid of producing a shuffle mask not in the input
|
|
// program, because the code gen may not be smart enough to turn a merged
|
|
// shuffle into two specific shuffles: it may produce worse code. As such,
|
|
// we only merge two shuffles if the result is one of the two input shuffle
|
|
// masks. In this case, merging the shuffles just removes one instruction,
|
|
// which we know is safe. This is good for things like turning:
|
|
// (splat(splat)) -> splat.
|
|
if (ShuffleVectorInst *LHSSVI = dyn_cast<ShuffleVectorInst>(LHS)) {
|
|
if (isa<UndefValue>(RHS)) {
|
|
std::vector<unsigned> LHSMask = getShuffleMask(LHSSVI);
|
|
|
|
if (LHSMask.size() == Mask.size()) {
|
|
std::vector<unsigned> NewMask;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = Mask.size(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
if (Mask[i] >= e)
|
|
NewMask.push_back(2*e);
|
|
else
|
|
NewMask.push_back(LHSMask[Mask[i]]);
|
|
|
|
// If the result mask is equal to the src shuffle or this
|
|
// shuffle mask, do the replacement.
|
|
if (NewMask == LHSMask || NewMask == Mask) {
|
|
unsigned LHSInNElts =
|
|
cast<VectorType>(LHSSVI->getOperand(0)->getType())->
|
|
getNumElements();
|
|
std::vector<Constant*> Elts;
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = NewMask.size(); i != e; ++i) {
|
|
if (NewMask[i] >= LHSInNElts*2) {
|
|
Elts.push_back(UndefValue::get(
|
|
Type::getInt32Ty(SVI.getContext())));
|
|
} else {
|
|
Elts.push_back(ConstantInt::get(
|
|
Type::getInt32Ty(SVI.getContext()),
|
|
NewMask[i]));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
return new ShuffleVectorInst(LHSSVI->getOperand(0),
|
|
LHSSVI->getOperand(1),
|
|
ConstantVector::get(Elts));
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
return MadeChange ? &SVI : 0;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// TryToSinkInstruction - Try to move the specified instruction from its
|
|
/// current block into the beginning of DestBlock, which can only happen if it's
|
|
/// safe to move the instruction past all of the instructions between it and the
|
|
/// end of its block.
|
|
static bool TryToSinkInstruction(Instruction *I, BasicBlock *DestBlock) {
|
|
assert(I->hasOneUse() && "Invariants didn't hold!");
|
|
|
|
// Cannot move control-flow-involving, volatile loads, vaarg, etc.
|
|
if (isa<PHINode>(I) || I->mayHaveSideEffects() || isa<TerminatorInst>(I))
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// Do not sink alloca instructions out of the entry block.
|
|
if (isa<AllocaInst>(I) && I->getParent() ==
|
|
&DestBlock->getParent()->getEntryBlock())
|
|
return false;
|
|
|
|
// We can only sink load instructions if there is nothing between the load and
|
|
// the end of block that could change the value.
|
|
if (I->mayReadFromMemory()) {
|
|
for (BasicBlock::iterator Scan = I, E = I->getParent()->end();
|
|
Scan != E; ++Scan)
|
|
if (Scan->mayWriteToMemory())
|
|
return false;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = DestBlock->getFirstNonPHI();
|
|
|
|
I->moveBefore(InsertPos);
|
|
++NumSunkInst;
|
|
return true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// AddReachableCodeToWorklist - Walk the function in depth-first order, adding
|
|
/// all reachable code to the worklist.
|
|
///
|
|
/// This has a couple of tricks to make the code faster and more powerful. In
|
|
/// particular, we constant fold and DCE instructions as we go, to avoid adding
|
|
/// them to the worklist (this significantly speeds up instcombine on code where
|
|
/// many instructions are dead or constant). Additionally, if we find a branch
|
|
/// whose condition is a known constant, we only visit the reachable successors.
|
|
///
|
|
static bool AddReachableCodeToWorklist(BasicBlock *BB,
|
|
SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> &Visited,
|
|
InstCombiner &IC,
|
|
const TargetData *TD) {
|
|
bool MadeIRChange = false;
|
|
SmallVector<BasicBlock*, 256> Worklist;
|
|
Worklist.push_back(BB);
|
|
|
|
std::vector<Instruction*> InstrsForInstCombineWorklist;
|
|
InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.reserve(128);
|
|
|
|
SmallPtrSet<ConstantExpr*, 64> FoldedConstants;
|
|
|
|
while (!Worklist.empty()) {
|
|
BB = Worklist.back();
|
|
Worklist.pop_back();
|
|
|
|
// We have now visited this block! If we've already been here, ignore it.
|
|
if (!Visited.insert(BB)) continue;
|
|
|
|
for (BasicBlock::iterator BBI = BB->begin(), E = BB->end(); BBI != E; ) {
|
|
Instruction *Inst = BBI++;
|
|
|
|
// DCE instruction if trivially dead.
|
|
if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(Inst)) {
|
|
++NumDeadInst;
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *Inst << '\n');
|
|
Inst->eraseFromParent();
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// ConstantProp instruction if trivially constant.
|
|
if (!Inst->use_empty() && isa<Constant>(Inst->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(Inst, TD)) {
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: "
|
|
<< *Inst << '\n');
|
|
Inst->replaceAllUsesWith(C);
|
|
++NumConstProp;
|
|
Inst->eraseFromParent();
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
|
if (TD) {
|
|
// See if we can constant fold its operands.
|
|
for (User::op_iterator i = Inst->op_begin(), e = Inst->op_end();
|
|
i != e; ++i) {
|
|
ConstantExpr *CE = dyn_cast<ConstantExpr>(i);
|
|
if (CE == 0) continue;
|
|
|
|
// If we already folded this constant, don't try again.
|
|
if (!FoldedConstants.insert(CE))
|
|
continue;
|
|
|
|
Constant *NewC = ConstantFoldConstantExpression(CE, TD);
|
|
if (NewC && NewC != CE) {
|
|
*i = NewC;
|
|
MadeIRChange = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.push_back(Inst);
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Recursively visit successors. If this is a branch or switch on a
|
|
// constant, only visit the reachable successor.
|
|
TerminatorInst *TI = BB->getTerminator();
|
|
if (BranchInst *BI = dyn_cast<BranchInst>(TI)) {
|
|
if (BI->isConditional() && isa<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())) {
|
|
bool CondVal = cast<ConstantInt>(BI->getCondition())->getZExtValue();
|
|
BasicBlock *ReachableBB = BI->getSuccessor(!CondVal);
|
|
Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
} else if (SwitchInst *SI = dyn_cast<SwitchInst>(TI)) {
|
|
if (ConstantInt *Cond = dyn_cast<ConstantInt>(SI->getCondition())) {
|
|
// See if this is an explicit destination.
|
|
for (unsigned i = 1, e = SI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
if (SI->getCaseValue(i) == Cond) {
|
|
BasicBlock *ReachableBB = SI->getSuccessor(i);
|
|
Worklist.push_back(ReachableBB);
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Otherwise it is the default destination.
|
|
Worklist.push_back(SI->getSuccessor(0));
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
for (unsigned i = 0, e = TI->getNumSuccessors(); i != e; ++i)
|
|
Worklist.push_back(TI->getSuccessor(i));
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Once we've found all of the instructions to add to instcombine's worklist,
|
|
// add them in reverse order. This way instcombine will visit from the top
|
|
// of the function down. This jives well with the way that it adds all uses
|
|
// of instructions to the worklist after doing a transformation, thus avoiding
|
|
// some N^2 behavior in pathological cases.
|
|
IC.Worklist.AddInitialGroup(&InstrsForInstCombineWorklist[0],
|
|
InstrsForInstCombineWorklist.size());
|
|
|
|
return MadeIRChange;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
bool InstCombiner::DoOneIteration(Function &F, unsigned Iteration) {
|
|
MadeIRChange = false;
|
|
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "\n\nINSTCOMBINE ITERATION #" << Iteration << " on "
|
|
<< F.getNameStr() << "\n");
|
|
|
|
{
|
|
// Do a depth-first traversal of the function, populate the worklist with
|
|
// the reachable instructions. Ignore blocks that are not reachable. Keep
|
|
// track of which blocks we visit.
|
|
SmallPtrSet<BasicBlock*, 64> Visited;
|
|
MadeIRChange |= AddReachableCodeToWorklist(F.begin(), Visited, *this, TD);
|
|
|
|
// Do a quick scan over the function. If we find any blocks that are
|
|
// unreachable, remove any instructions inside of them. This prevents
|
|
// the instcombine code from having to deal with some bad special cases.
|
|
for (Function::iterator BB = F.begin(), E = F.end(); BB != E; ++BB)
|
|
if (!Visited.count(BB)) {
|
|
Instruction *Term = BB->getTerminator();
|
|
while (Term != BB->begin()) { // Remove instrs bottom-up
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator I = Term; --I;
|
|
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
|
|
// A debug intrinsic shouldn't force another iteration if we weren't
|
|
// going to do one without it.
|
|
if (!isa<DbgInfoIntrinsic>(I)) {
|
|
++NumDeadInst;
|
|
MadeIRChange = true;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If I is not void type then replaceAllUsesWith undef.
|
|
// This allows ValueHandlers and custom metadata to adjust itself.
|
|
if (!I->getType()->isVoidTy())
|
|
I->replaceAllUsesWith(UndefValue::get(I->getType()));
|
|
I->eraseFromParent();
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
while (!Worklist.isEmpty()) {
|
|
Instruction *I = Worklist.RemoveOne();
|
|
if (I == 0) continue; // skip null values.
|
|
|
|
// Check to see if we can DCE the instruction.
|
|
if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: DCE: " << *I << '\n');
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
|
|
++NumDeadInst;
|
|
MadeIRChange = true;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Instruction isn't dead, see if we can constant propagate it.
|
|
if (!I->use_empty() && isa<Constant>(I->getOperand(0)))
|
|
if (Constant *C = ConstantFoldInstruction(I, TD)) {
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: ConstFold to: " << *C << " from: " << *I << '\n');
|
|
|
|
// Add operands to the worklist.
|
|
ReplaceInstUsesWith(*I, C);
|
|
++NumConstProp;
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
|
|
MadeIRChange = true;
|
|
continue;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// See if we can trivially sink this instruction to a successor basic block.
|
|
if (I->hasOneUse()) {
|
|
BasicBlock *BB = I->getParent();
|
|
Instruction *UserInst = cast<Instruction>(I->use_back());
|
|
BasicBlock *UserParent;
|
|
|
|
// Get the block the use occurs in.
|
|
if (PHINode *PN = dyn_cast<PHINode>(UserInst))
|
|
UserParent = PN->getIncomingBlock(I->use_begin().getUse());
|
|
else
|
|
UserParent = UserInst->getParent();
|
|
|
|
if (UserParent != BB) {
|
|
bool UserIsSuccessor = false;
|
|
// See if the user is one of our successors.
|
|
for (succ_iterator SI = succ_begin(BB), E = succ_end(BB); SI != E; ++SI)
|
|
if (*SI == UserParent) {
|
|
UserIsSuccessor = true;
|
|
break;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// If the user is one of our immediate successors, and if that successor
|
|
// only has us as a predecessors (we'd have to split the critical edge
|
|
// otherwise), we can keep going.
|
|
if (UserIsSuccessor && UserParent->getSinglePredecessor())
|
|
// Okay, the CFG is simple enough, try to sink this instruction.
|
|
MadeIRChange |= TryToSinkInstruction(I, UserParent);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
// Now that we have an instruction, try combining it to simplify it.
|
|
Builder->SetInsertPoint(I->getParent(), I);
|
|
|
|
#ifndef NDEBUG
|
|
std::string OrigI;
|
|
#endif
|
|
DEBUG(raw_string_ostream SS(OrigI); I->print(SS); OrigI = SS.str(););
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Visiting: " << OrigI << '\n');
|
|
|
|
if (Instruction *Result = visit(*I)) {
|
|
++NumCombined;
|
|
// Should we replace the old instruction with a new one?
|
|
if (Result != I) {
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Old = " << *I << '\n'
|
|
<< " New = " << *Result << '\n');
|
|
|
|
// Everything uses the new instruction now.
|
|
I->replaceAllUsesWith(Result);
|
|
|
|
// Push the new instruction and any users onto the worklist.
|
|
Worklist.Add(Result);
|
|
Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*Result);
|
|
|
|
// Move the name to the new instruction first.
|
|
Result->takeName(I);
|
|
|
|
// Insert the new instruction into the basic block...
|
|
BasicBlock *InstParent = I->getParent();
|
|
BasicBlock::iterator InsertPos = I;
|
|
|
|
if (!isa<PHINode>(Result)) // If combining a PHI, don't insert
|
|
while (isa<PHINode>(InsertPos)) // middle of a block of PHIs.
|
|
++InsertPos;
|
|
|
|
InstParent->getInstList().insert(InsertPos, Result);
|
|
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
|
|
} else {
|
|
#ifndef NDEBUG
|
|
DEBUG(errs() << "IC: Mod = " << OrigI << '\n'
|
|
<< " New = " << *I << '\n');
|
|
#endif
|
|
|
|
// If the instruction was modified, it's possible that it is now dead.
|
|
// if so, remove it.
|
|
if (isInstructionTriviallyDead(I)) {
|
|
EraseInstFromFunction(*I);
|
|
} else {
|
|
Worklist.Add(I);
|
|
Worklist.AddUsersToWorkList(*I);
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
MadeIRChange = true;
|
|
}
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
Worklist.Zap();
|
|
return MadeIRChange;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
|
|
bool InstCombiner::runOnFunction(Function &F) {
|
|
MustPreserveLCSSA = mustPreserveAnalysisID(LCSSAID);
|
|
TD = getAnalysisIfAvailable<TargetData>();
|
|
|
|
|
|
/// Builder - This is an IRBuilder that automatically inserts new
|
|
/// instructions into the worklist when they are created.
|
|
IRBuilder<true, TargetFolder, InstCombineIRInserter>
|
|
TheBuilder(F.getContext(), TargetFolder(TD),
|
|
InstCombineIRInserter(Worklist));
|
|
Builder = &TheBuilder;
|
|
|
|
bool EverMadeChange = false;
|
|
|
|
// Iterate while there is work to do.
|
|
unsigned Iteration = 0;
|
|
while (DoOneIteration(F, Iteration++))
|
|
EverMadeChange = true;
|
|
|
|
Builder = 0;
|
|
return EverMadeChange;
|
|
}
|
|
|
|
FunctionPass *llvm::createInstructionCombiningPass() {
|
|
return new InstCombiner();
|
|
}
|